weather: Report continuous integration stats.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14
15 @copying
16 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018 Ludovic Courtès@*
17 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
18 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
19 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
20 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
21 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
22 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
23 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017 Leo Famulari@*
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018 Ricardo Wurmus@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Efraim Flashner@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Nils Gillmann@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Clément Lassieur@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Mathieu Othacehe@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Carlo Zancanaro@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Marius Bakke@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Hartmut Goebel@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Maxim Cournoyer@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Arun Isaac@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
55 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
56 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
57 Documentation License''.
58 @end copying
59
60 @dircategory System administration
61 @direntry
62 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
63 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
64 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
65 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
66 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
67 @end direntry
68
69 @dircategory Software development
70 @direntry
71 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
72 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
73 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
74 @end direntry
75
76 @titlepage
77 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
78 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
79 @author The GNU Guix Developers
80
81 @page
82 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
83 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
84 @value{UPDATED} @*
85
86 @insertcopying
87 @end titlepage
88
89 @contents
90
91 @c *********************************************************************
92 @node Top
93 @top GNU Guix
94
95 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
96 package management tool written for the GNU system.
97
98 @menu
99 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
100 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
101 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
102 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
103 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
104 * GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
105 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
106
107 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
108 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
109 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
110 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
111
112 @detailmenu
113 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
114
115 Installation
116
117 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
118 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
119 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
120 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
121 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
122 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
123
124 Setting Up the Daemon
125
126 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
127 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
128 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
129
130 Package Management
131
132 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
133 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
134 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
135 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
136 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
137 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
138 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
139 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
140
141 Substitutes
142
143 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
144 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
145 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
146 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
147 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
148 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
149
150 Programming Interface
151
152 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
153 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
154 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
155 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
156 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
157 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
158
159 Defining Packages
160
161 * package Reference :: The package data type.
162 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
163
164 Utilities
165
166 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
167 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
168 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
169 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
170 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
171 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
172 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
173 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
174 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
175 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
176 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
177 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
178 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
179 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
180 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
181
182 Invoking @command{guix build}
183
184 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
185 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
186 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
187 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
188
189 GNU Distribution
190
191 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
192 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
193 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
194 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
195 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
196 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
197 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
198 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
199 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
200
201 System Installation
202
203 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
204 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
205 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
206 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
207 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
208 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
209 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
210
211 System Configuration
212
213 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
214 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
215 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
216 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
217 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
218 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
219 * Services:: Specifying system services.
220 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
221 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
222 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
223 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
224 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
225 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
226 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
227 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
228
229 Services
230
231 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
232 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
233 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
234 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
235 * X Window:: Graphical display.
236 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
237 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
238 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
239 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
240 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
241 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
242 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
243 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
244 * Web Services:: Web servers.
245 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
246 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
247 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
248 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
249 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
250 * Power management Services:: The TLP tool.
251 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
252 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
253 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
254 * Game Services:: Game servers.
255 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
256
257 Defining Services
258
259 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
260 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
261 * Service Reference:: API reference.
262 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
263
264 Packaging Guidelines
265
266 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
267 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
268 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
269 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
270 * Python Modules:: A touch of British comedy.
271 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
272 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
273 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
274
275 Contributing
276
277 * Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
278 * Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
279 * The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
280 * Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
281 * Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
282
283 Coding Style
284
285 * Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
286 * Modules:: Where to store your code?
287 * Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
288 * Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
289
290 @end detailmenu
291 @end menu
292
293 @c *********************************************************************
294 @node Introduction
295 @chapter Introduction
296
297 @cindex purpose
298 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
299 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
300 management tool for the GNU system. Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
301 users to install, upgrade, or remove packages, to roll back to a
302 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
303 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
304
305 @cindex user interfaces
306 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
307 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}), a set of command-line utilities
308 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
309 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
310 @cindex build daemon
311 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
312 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
313 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
314
315 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
316 @cindex customization, of packages
317 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
318 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
319 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
320 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
321 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
322 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
323 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
324 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
325
326 @cindex Guix System Distribution
327 @cindex GuixSD
328 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system
329 where it complements the available tools without interference
330 (@pxref{Installation}), or you can use it as part of the standalone
331 @dfn{Guix System Distribution} or GuixSD (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
332 With GNU@tie{}GuixSD, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating
333 system configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the
334 configuration in a transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion
335 (@pxref{System Configuration}).
336
337 @cindex functional package management
338 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
339 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
340 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
341 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
342 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
343 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
344 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
345 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
346 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
347 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
348 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
349 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
350 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
351 explicit inputs are visible.
352
353 @cindex store
354 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
355 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
356 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
357 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
358 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
359 input yields a different directory name.
360
361 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
362 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
363 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
364
365
366 @c *********************************************************************
367 @node Installation
368 @chapter Installation
369
370 @cindex installing Guix
371 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
372 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
373 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
374 ready to use it.
375
376 Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
377 manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
378 instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
379 @pxref{System Installation}.
380
381 @cindex foreign distro
382 When installed on a running GNU/Linux system---thereafter called a
383 @dfn{foreign distro}---GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available tools
384 without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
385 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your
386 system, such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
387
388 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
389 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
390
391 @menu
392 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
393 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
394 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
395 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
396 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
397 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
398 @end menu
399
400 @node Binary Installation
401 @section Binary Installation
402
403 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
404 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
405 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
406 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
407 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
408 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
409
410 We provide a
411 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
412 shell installer script}, which automates the download, installation, and
413 initial configuration of Guix. It should be run as the root user.
414
415 Installing goes along these lines:
416
417 @enumerate
418 @item
419 @cindex downloading Guix binary
420 Download the binary tarball from
421 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
422 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
423 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
424
425 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
426 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
427 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
428
429 @example
430 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
431 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
432 @end example
433
434 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
435 then run this command to import it:
436
437 @example
438 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
439 @end example
440
441 @noindent
442 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
443 @c end authentication part
444
445 @item
446 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
447 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
448
449 @example
450 # cd /tmp
451 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
452 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
453 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
454 @end example
455
456 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
457 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
458 step.)
459
460 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
461 would overwrite its own essential files.
462
463 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
464 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
465 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
466 versions are fine.)
467 They stem from the fact that all the
468 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
469 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
470 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
471 reproducible.
472
473 @item
474 Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
475
476 @example
477 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
478 ~root/.guix-profile
479 @end example
480
481 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @code{PATH} and other relevant
482 environment variables:
483
484 @example
485 # GUIX_PROFILE=$HOME/.guix-profile ; \
486 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
487 @end example
488
489 @item
490 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
491 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
492
493 @item
494 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
495
496 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
497 with these commands:
498
499 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
500 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
501 @c files into place.
502 @c
503 @c See this thread for more information:
504 @c http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
505
506 @example
507 # cp ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
508 /etc/systemd/system/
509 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
510 @end example
511
512 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
513
514 @example
515 # initctl reload-configuration
516 # cp ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf /etc/init/
517 # start guix-daemon
518 @end example
519
520 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
521
522 @example
523 # ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
524 @end example
525
526 @item
527 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
528 for instance with:
529
530 @example
531 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
532 # cd /usr/local/bin
533 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
534 @end example
535
536 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
537 there:
538
539 @example
540 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
541 # cd /usr/local/share/info
542 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
543 do ln -s $i ; done
544 @end example
545
546 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
547 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
548 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
549 Info search path.)
550
551 @item
552 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
553 To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or one of its mirrors
554 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
555
556 @example
557 # guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
558 @end example
559
560 @item
561 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
562 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
563 @end enumerate
564
565 Voilà, the installation is complete!
566
567 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
568 the root profile:
569
570 @example
571 # guix package -i hello
572 @end example
573
574 The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s profile,
575 or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which case you
576 would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the @command{guix}
577 command. In other words, do not remove @code{guix} by running
578 @code{guix package -r guix}.
579
580 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
581 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
582
583 @example
584 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
585 @end example
586
587 @noindent
588 ... which, in turn, runs:
589
590 @example
591 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir guix
592 @end example
593
594 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
595
596 @node Requirements
597 @section Requirements
598
599 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
600 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
601 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
602 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
603
604 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
605
606 @itemize
607 @item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.13 or
608 later, including 2.2.x;
609 @item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
610 @item
611 @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
612 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
613 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
614 @item
615 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
616 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
617 2017 or later;
618 @item @url{http://zlib.net, zlib};
619 @item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
620 @end itemize
621
622 The following dependencies are optional:
623
624 @itemize
625 @item
626 Installing
627 @url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
628 allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
629 guix import}). It is of
630 interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
631
632 @item
633 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
634 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
635 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
636 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
637 version 0.10.2 or later.
638
639 @item
640 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
641 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
642 @end itemize
643
644 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
645 following packages are also needed:
646
647 @itemize
648 @item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
649 @item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
650 C++11 standard.
651 @end itemize
652
653 @cindex state directory
654 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
655 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
656 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
657 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
658 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
659 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
660 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
661
662 @cindex Nix, compatibility
663 When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
664 manager} is available, you
665 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
666 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
667
668 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
669 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
670 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
671 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
672 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
673 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
674 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
675 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
676 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
677
678 @node Running the Test Suite
679 @section Running the Test Suite
680
681 @cindex test suite
682 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
683 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
684 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
685 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
686 suite, type:
687
688 @example
689 make check
690 @end example
691
692 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
693 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
694 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
695 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
696 cache.
697
698 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
699 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
700
701 @example
702 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
703 @end example
704
705 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
706 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
707 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
708
709 @example
710 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
711 @end example
712
713 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
714 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
715 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
716 your message.
717
718 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
719 GuixSD operating system instances. It can only run on systems where
720 Guix is already installed, using:
721
722 @example
723 make check-system
724 @end example
725
726 @noindent
727 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
728
729 @example
730 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
731 @end example
732
733 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
734 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
735 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
736 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
737 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
738 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
739
740 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
741 all the details.
742
743 @node Setting Up the Daemon
744 @section Setting Up the Daemon
745
746 @cindex daemon
747 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
748 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
749 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
750 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
751 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
752 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
753 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
754
755 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
756 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
757 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
758
759 @menu
760 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
761 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
762 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
763 @end menu
764
765 @node Build Environment Setup
766 @subsection Build Environment Setup
767
768 @cindex build environment
769 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
770 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
771 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
772 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
773 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
774 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
775 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
776
777 @cindex build users
778 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
779 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
780 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
781 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
782 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
783 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
784 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
785 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
786 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
787 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
788
789 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
790 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
791
792 @c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
793 @c for why `-G' is needed.
794 @example
795 # groupadd --system guixbuild
796 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
797 do
798 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
799 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
800 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
801 guixbuilder$i;
802 done
803 @end example
804
805 @noindent
806 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
807 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
808 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
809 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
810 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
811 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
812 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
813
814 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
815 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
816 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
817 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
818 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
819 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
820 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
821 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
822
823 @example
824 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
825 @end example
826
827 @cindex chroot
828 @noindent
829 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
830 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
831 environment contains nothing but:
832
833 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
834 @itemize
835 @item
836 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
837 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
838 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
839 can only be created if the host has them.};
840
841 @item
842 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
843 since a separate PID name space is used;
844
845 @item
846 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
847 user @file{nobody};
848
849 @item
850 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
851
852 @item
853 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
854 @code{127.0.0.1};
855
856 @item
857 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
858 @end itemize
859
860 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
861 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
862 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
863 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
864 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
865 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
866 capture the name of their build tree.
867
868 @vindex http_proxy
869 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
870 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
871 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
872
873 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
874 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
875 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
876 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
877 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
878 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
879 @emph{pure} functions.
880
881
882 @node Daemon Offload Setup
883 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
884
885 @cindex offloading
886 @cindex build hook
887 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
888 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
889 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
890 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
891 present.}. When that
892 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
893 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
894 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
895 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
896 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
897 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
898 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
899 build are copied back to the initial machine.
900
901 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
902
903 @example
904 (list (build-machine
905 (name "eightysix.example.org")
906 (system "x86_64-linux")
907 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
908 (user "bob")
909 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
910
911 (build-machine
912 (name "meeps.example.org")
913 (system "mips64el-linux")
914 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
915 (user "alice")
916 (private-key
917 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
918 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
919 @end example
920
921 @noindent
922 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
923 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
924 architecture.
925
926 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
927 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
928 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
929 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
930 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
931 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
932 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
933 detailed below.
934
935 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
936 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
937 builds. The important fields are:
938
939 @table @code
940
941 @item name
942 The host name of the remote machine.
943
944 @item system
945 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
946
947 @item user
948 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
949 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
950 allow non-interactive logins.
951
952 @item host-key
953 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
954 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
955 long string that looks like this:
956
957 @example
958 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
959 @end example
960
961 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
962 key can be found in a file such as
963 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
964
965 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
966 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
967 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
968 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
969
970 @example
971 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
972 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
973 @end example
974
975 @end table
976
977 A number of optional fields may be specified:
978
979 @table @asis
980
981 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
982 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
983
984 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
985 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
986 OpenSSH format.
987
988 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
989 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
990
991 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
992 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
993 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
994
995 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
996 when transferring files to and from build machines.
997
998 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
999 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1000 to on that machine.
1001
1002 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1003 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1004
1005 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1006 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1007 machines with a higher speed factor.
1008
1009 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1010 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1011 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1012 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1013 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1014
1015 @end table
1016 @end deftp
1017
1018 The @code{guile} command must be in the search path on the build
1019 machines. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
1020 @code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
1021 this is the case by running:
1022
1023 @example
1024 ssh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
1025 @end example
1026
1027 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1028 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1029 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1030 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1031 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1032
1033 @example
1034 # guix archive --generate-key
1035 @end example
1036
1037 @noindent
1038 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1039 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1040
1041 @example
1042 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1043 @end example
1044
1045 @noindent
1046 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1047
1048 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1049 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1050 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1051 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1052 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1053
1054 @cindex offload test
1055 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1056 master node:
1057
1058 @example
1059 # guix offload test
1060 @end example
1061
1062 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1063 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1064 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1065 from it, and report any error in the process.
1066
1067 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1068 command line:
1069
1070 @example
1071 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1072 @end example
1073
1074 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1075 regular expression like this:
1076
1077 @example
1078 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1079 @end example
1080
1081 @cindex offload status
1082 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1083 main node:
1084
1085 @example
1086 # guix offload status
1087 @end example
1088
1089
1090 @node SELinux Support
1091 @subsection SELinux Support
1092
1093 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1094 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1095 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1096 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1097 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1098 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1099 GuixSD does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1100 be used on GuixSD.
1101
1102 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1103 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1104 To install the policy run this command as root:
1105
1106 @example
1107 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1108 @end example
1109
1110 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1111 mechanism provided by your system.
1112
1113 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1114 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1115 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1116 command:
1117
1118 @example
1119 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1120 @end example
1121
1122 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1123 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1124 operations.
1125
1126 @subsubsection Limitations
1127 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1128
1129 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1130 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1131 the Guix daemon.
1132
1133 @enumerate
1134 @item
1135 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1136 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1137 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1138 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1139
1140 @item
1141 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1142 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1143 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1144 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1145 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1146 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1147 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1148 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1149 reading and following these links.
1150
1151 @item
1152 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1153 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1154 differently from files.
1155
1156 @item
1157 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1158 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1159 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1160 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1161 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1162 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1163 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1164 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1165 allowed for processes in that domain.
1166
1167 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1168 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1169 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1170 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1171 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1172 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1173 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1174 @end enumerate
1175
1176 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1177 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1178
1179 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1180 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1181 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1182 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1183
1184 @example
1185 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1186 @end example
1187
1188 @noindent
1189 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1190
1191 @cindex chroot
1192 @cindex container, build environment
1193 @cindex build environment
1194 @cindex reproducible builds
1195 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1196 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1197 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1198 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1199 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1200 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1201 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1202 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1203 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1204 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1205 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1206
1207 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1208 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1209 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
1210 the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
1211 directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
1212 with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
1213 sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
1214 it would otherwise not hit.
1215
1216 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1217 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1218 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1219
1220 The following command-line options are supported:
1221
1222 @table @code
1223 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1224 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1225 the Daemon, build users}).
1226
1227 @item --no-substitutes
1228 @cindex substitutes
1229 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1230 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1231 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1232
1233 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1234 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1235 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1236
1237 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1238 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1239 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1240 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1241 @indicateurl{https://mirror.hydra.gnu.org https://hydra.gnu.org} is used
1242 (@code{mirror.hydra.gnu.org} is a mirror of @code{hydra.gnu.org}).
1243
1244 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1245 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1246
1247 @cindex build hook
1248 @item --no-build-hook
1249 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1250
1251 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1252 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1253 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1254
1255 @item --cache-failures
1256 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1257
1258 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1259 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1260 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1261 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1262
1263 @item --cores=@var{n}
1264 @itemx -c @var{n}
1265 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1266 as available.
1267
1268 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1269 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1270 guix build}).
1271
1272 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1273 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1274 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1275
1276 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1277 @itemx -M @var{n}
1278 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1279 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1280 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1281 Setup}), or simply fail.
1282
1283 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1284 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1285 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1286
1287 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1288
1289 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1290 Build Options, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
1291
1292 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1293 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1294 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1295
1296 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1297
1298 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1299 Build Options, @code{--timeout}}).
1300
1301 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1302 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1303 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1304 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1305 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1306
1307 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1308 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1309 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1310
1311 @item --debug
1312 Produce debugging output.
1313
1314 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1315 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1316 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1317
1318 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1319 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1320
1321 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1322 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1323 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1324 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1325 needs.
1326
1327 @item --disable-chroot
1328 Disable chroot builds.
1329
1330 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1331 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1332 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1333 account.
1334
1335 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1336 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1337 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1338
1339 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1340 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1341 them with bzip2 by default.
1342
1343 @item --disable-deduplication
1344 @cindex deduplication
1345 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1346
1347 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1348 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1349 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1350 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1351 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1352 this optimization.
1353
1354 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1355 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1356 derivations.
1357
1358 @cindex GC roots
1359 @cindex garbage collector roots
1360 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1361 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1362 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
1363 @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC roots.
1364
1365 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1366 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1367 corresponding to live outputs.
1368
1369 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1370 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1371 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1372 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1373
1374 Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
1375 @code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
1376 prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
1377 tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
1378 prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
1379 saves rebuilds or downloads.
1380
1381 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1382 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1383 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1384
1385 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1386 on the kernel version number.
1387
1388 @item --lose-logs
1389 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1390 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1391
1392 @item --system=@var{system}
1393 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1394 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1395 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1396
1397 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1398 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1399 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1400 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1401 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1402
1403 @table @code
1404 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1405 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1406 creating it if needed.
1407
1408 @item --listen=localhost
1409 @cindex daemon, remote access
1410 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1411 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1412 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1413 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1414 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1415
1416 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1417 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1418 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1419 @end table
1420
1421 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1422 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1423 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1424 by setting the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1425 (@pxref{The Store, @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1426
1427 @quotation Note
1428 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1429 @code{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1430 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1431 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1432 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1433 @end quotation
1434
1435 When @code{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1436 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1437 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1438 @end table
1439
1440
1441 @node Application Setup
1442 @section Application Setup
1443
1444 @cindex foreign distro
1445 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1446 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1447 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1448
1449 @subsection Locales
1450
1451 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1452 @cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
1453 @vindex LOCPATH
1454 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1455 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1456 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1457 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1458 variable:
1459
1460 @example
1461 $ guix package -i glibc-locales
1462 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1463 @end example
1464
1465 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1466 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1467 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1468 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1469
1470 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1471 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1472 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1473
1474 @enumerate
1475 @item
1476 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1477 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1478 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1479 incompatible locale data.
1480
1481 @item
1482 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1483 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1484 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1485 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1486 data in the right format.
1487 @end enumerate
1488
1489 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1490 versions may be incompatible.
1491
1492 @subsection Name Service Switch
1493
1494 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1495 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1496 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1497 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1498 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1499 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1500 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1501 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1502 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1503 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1504
1505 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1506 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1507 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1508 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1509 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1510
1511 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1512 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1513 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1514 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1515 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1516 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1517 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1518 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1519 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1520 Reference Manual}).
1521
1522 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1523 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1524 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1525 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1526 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1527 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1528 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1529 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1530 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1531
1532 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1533 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1534 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1535 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1536
1537 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1538 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1539 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1540 themselves.
1541
1542 @subsection X11 Fonts
1543
1544 @cindex fonts
1545 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1546 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1547 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1548 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1549 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1550 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1551 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1552
1553 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1554 graphical applications, consider installing
1555 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1556 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1557 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1558 for Chinese languages:
1559
1560 @example
1561 guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1562 @end example
1563
1564 @cindex @code{xterm}
1565 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1566 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1567 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1568
1569 @example
1570 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1571 @end example
1572
1573 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1574 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1575
1576 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1577 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1578 @example
1579 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1580 @end example
1581
1582 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1583 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1584 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1585
1586 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1587 @cindex font cache
1588 After installing fonts you may have to refresh the font cache to use
1589 them in applications. The same applies when applications installed via
1590 Guix do not seem to find fonts. To force rebuilding of the font cache
1591 run @code{fc-cache -f}. The @code{fc-cache} command is provided by the
1592 @code{fontconfig} package.
1593
1594 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1595
1596 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1597 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1598 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1599
1600 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1601 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1602 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1603 information.
1604
1605 @subsection Emacs Packages
1606
1607 @cindex @code{emacs}
1608 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1609 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1610 sub-directories of
1611 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1612 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1613 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may not be
1614 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1615 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1616 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1617 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1618
1619 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1620 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1621 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1622 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1623 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1624
1625 @subsection The GCC toolchain
1626
1627 @cindex GCC
1628 @cindex ld-wrapper
1629
1630 Guix offers individual compiler packages such as @code{gcc} but if you
1631 are in need of a complete toolchain for compiling and linking source
1632 code what you really want is the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This
1633 package provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development,
1634 including GCC itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus
1635 debugging symbols in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker
1636 wrapper.
1637
1638 @cindex attempt to use impure library, error message
1639
1640 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
1641 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
1642 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. By default,
1643 the linker wrapper refuses to link to libraries outside the store to
1644 ensure ``purity''. This can be annoying when using the toolchain to
1645 link with local libraries. To allow references to libraries outside the
1646 store you need to define the environment variable
1647 @code{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES}.
1648
1649 @c TODO What else?
1650
1651 @c *********************************************************************
1652 @node Package Management
1653 @chapter Package Management
1654
1655 @cindex packages
1656 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
1657 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
1658 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
1659 features.
1660
1661 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
1662 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
1663 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
1664 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
1665 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
1666 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
1667 with it):
1668
1669 @example
1670 guix package -i emacs-guix
1671 @end example
1672
1673 @menu
1674 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
1675 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
1676 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
1677 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
1678 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
1679 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
1680 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
1681 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
1682 @end menu
1683
1684 @node Features
1685 @section Features
1686
1687 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1688 own directory---something that resembles
1689 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
1690
1691 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1692 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
1693 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1694 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
1695
1696 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
1697 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
1698 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
1699 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1700 simply continues to point to
1701 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
1702 coexist on the same system without any interference.
1703
1704 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
1705 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
1706 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
1707
1708 @cindex transactions
1709 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1710 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
1711 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
1712 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
1713 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1714 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1715
1716 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1717 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1718 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
1719 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1720 system configuration on GuixSD is subject to
1721 transactional upgrades and roll-back
1722 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
1723
1724 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1725 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
1726 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
1727 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
1728 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1729 collected.
1730
1731 @cindex reproducibility
1732 @cindex reproducible builds
1733 Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1734 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
1735 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
1736 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1737 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1738 given package installation matches the current state of their
1739 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1740 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1741 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1742 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
1743
1744 @cindex substitutes
1745 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
1746 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
1747 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
1748 downloads it and unpacks it;
1749 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1750 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
1751 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
1752 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
1753 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
1754
1755 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1756 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1757 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
1758 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
1759 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1760
1761 @node Invoking guix package
1762 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
1763
1764 @cindex installing packages
1765 @cindex removing packages
1766 @cindex package installation
1767 @cindex package removal
1768 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
1769 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1770 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1771 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1772 is:
1773
1774 @example
1775 guix package @var{options}
1776 @end example
1777 @cindex transactions
1778 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
1779 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
1780 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
1781 want to roll back.
1782
1783 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1784 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1785
1786 @example
1787 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1788 @end example
1789
1790 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1791 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1792 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1793 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1794
1795 @cindex profile
1796 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
1797 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
1798 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1799 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1800 variable, and so on.
1801 @cindex search paths
1802 If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1803 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1804 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1805 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1806
1807 @example
1808 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
1809 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1810 @end example
1811
1812 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1813 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1814 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
1815 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1816 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
1817 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1818 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1819 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1820 package}.
1821
1822 The @var{options} can be among the following:
1823
1824 @table @code
1825
1826 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1827 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1828 Install the specified @var{package}s.
1829
1830 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
1831 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
1832 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
1833 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1834
1835 If no version number is specified, the
1836 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1837 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
1838 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
1839 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1840 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1841 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
1842
1843 @cindex propagated inputs
1844 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
1845 that automatically get installed along with the required package
1846 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1847 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1848 package definitions).
1849
1850 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
1851 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1852 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1853 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1854 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
1855 also been explicitly installed by the user.
1856
1857 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
1858 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
1859 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
1860 environment variable definitions are reported here.
1861
1862 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1863 @itemx -e @var{exp}
1864 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1865
1866 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1867 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1868 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1869 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1870
1871 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1872 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1873 multiple-output package.
1874
1875 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1876 @itemx -f @var{file}
1877 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1878
1879 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1880 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1881
1882 @example
1883 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1884 @end example
1885
1886 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
1887 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
1888 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1889 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1890
1891 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1892 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1893 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
1894
1895 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
1896 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1897 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1898 @code{glibc}.
1899
1900 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1901 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1902 @cindex upgrading packages
1903 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1904 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
1905 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
1906
1907 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1908 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1909 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1910 pull}).
1911
1912 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1913 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1914 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1915 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1916 substring ``emacs'':
1917
1918 @example
1919 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1920 @end example
1921
1922 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1923 @itemx -m @var{file}
1924 @cindex profile declaration
1925 @cindex profile manifest
1926 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1927 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1928
1929 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1930 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1931 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1932 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1933 so on.
1934
1935 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1936 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1937 of packages:
1938
1939 @findex packages->manifest
1940 @example
1941 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
1942
1943 (packages->manifest
1944 (list emacs
1945 guile-2.0
1946 ;; Use a specific package output.
1947 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1948 @end example
1949
1950 @findex specifications->manifest
1951 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
1952 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
1953 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
1954 instead provide regular package specifications and let
1955 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
1956 objects, like this:
1957
1958 @example
1959 (specifications->manifest
1960 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
1961 @end example
1962
1963 @item --roll-back
1964 @cindex rolling back
1965 @cindex undoing transactions
1966 @cindex transactions, undoing
1967 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1968 the last transaction.
1969
1970 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1971 before any other actions.
1972
1973 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
1974 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
1975 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
1976
1977 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
1978 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
1979 generations in a profile is always linear.
1980
1981 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1982 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
1983 @cindex generations
1984 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1985
1986 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1987 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1988 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1989 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1990 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1991
1992 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1993 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1994 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1995 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1996
1997 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
1998 @cindex search paths
1999 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2000 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2001 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2002 of the installed packages.
2003
2004 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
2005 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2006 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2007 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2008 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
2009 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
2010 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2011
2012 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2013 shell:
2014
2015 @example
2016 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2017 @end example
2018
2019 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2020 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2021 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2022 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2023
2024 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2025 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2026
2027 @example
2028 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2029 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2030 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2031 @end example
2032
2033 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2034 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2035 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2036
2037
2038 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2039 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2040 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2041
2042 @item --verbose
2043 Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the build log of the
2044 environment on the standard error port.
2045
2046 @item --bootstrap
2047 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
2048 useful to distribution developers.
2049
2050 @end table
2051
2052 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
2053 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
2054 availability of packages:
2055
2056 @table @option
2057
2058 @item --search=@var{regexp}
2059 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
2060 @cindex searching for packages
2061 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
2062 @var{regexp}, sorted by relevance. Print all the metadata of matching packages in
2063 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
2064 GNU recutils manual}).
2065
2066 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
2067 command, for instance:
2068
2069 @example
2070 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
2071 name: jemalloc
2072 version: 4.5.0
2073 relevance: 6
2074
2075 name: glibc
2076 version: 2.25
2077 relevance: 1
2078
2079 name: libgc
2080 version: 7.6.0
2081 relevance: 1
2082 @end example
2083
2084 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
2085 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
2086
2087 @example
2088 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
2089 name: elfutils
2090
2091 name: gmp
2092 @dots{}
2093 @end example
2094
2095 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
2096 flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
2097 games:
2098
2099 @example
2100 $ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
2101 name: gnubg
2102 @dots{}
2103 @end example
2104
2105 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
2106 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
2107 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
2108 keyboards.
2109
2110 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
2111 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
2112 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
2113
2114 @example
2115 $ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
2116 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
2117 @end example
2118
2119 @noindent
2120 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
2121 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
2122
2123 @item --show=@var{package}
2124 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
2125 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
2126 recutils manual}).
2127
2128 @example
2129 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
2130 name: python
2131 version: 2.7.6
2132
2133 name: python
2134 version: 3.3.5
2135 @end example
2136
2137 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
2138 specific version of it:
2139 @example
2140 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
2141 name: python
2142 version: 3.4.3
2143 @end example
2144
2145
2146
2147 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
2148 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
2149 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
2150 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
2151 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
2152
2153 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
2154 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
2155 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
2156 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
2157 the store.
2158
2159 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
2160 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
2161 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
2162 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
2163 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
2164
2165 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
2166 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
2167 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
2168
2169 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
2170 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
2171 @cindex generations
2172 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
2173 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
2174 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
2175 shown.
2176
2177 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
2178 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
2179 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
2180 location of this package in the store.
2181
2182 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
2183 generations. Valid patterns include:
2184
2185 @itemize
2186 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
2187 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
2188 the first one.
2189
2190 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
2191 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
2192
2193 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
2194 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
2195 a range must be smaller than its end.
2196
2197 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
2198 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
2199 second one.
2200
2201 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
2202 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
2203 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
2204 that are up to 20 days old.
2205 @end itemize
2206
2207 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
2208 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
2209 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
2210 one.
2211
2212 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
2213 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
2214 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
2215 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
2216 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
2217
2218 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
2219 zeroth generation is never deleted.
2220
2221 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
2222 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
2223
2224 @end table
2225
2226 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
2227 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
2228 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
2229 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
2230 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
2231 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
2232 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
2233 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2234
2235 @node Substitutes
2236 @section Substitutes
2237
2238 @cindex substitutes
2239 @cindex pre-built binaries
2240 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
2241 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
2242 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
2243 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
2244 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
2245
2246 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
2247 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
2248 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
2249 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
2250
2251 @menu
2252 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
2253 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
2254 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
2255 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
2256 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
2257 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
2258 @end menu
2259
2260 @node Official Substitute Server
2261 @subsection Official Substitute Server
2262
2263 @cindex hydra
2264 @cindex build farm
2265 The @code{mirror.hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to an official build farm
2266 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
2267 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
2268 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
2269 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
2270 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
2271 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
2272 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
2273 option}).
2274
2275 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
2276 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
2277 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
2278 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
2279 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
2280
2281 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
2282 using the Guix System Distribution (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
2283 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
2284 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
2285 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
2286 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
2287 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
2288 other substitute server.
2289
2290 @node Substitute Server Authorization
2291 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
2292
2293 @cindex security
2294 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
2295 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
2296 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
2297 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or a
2298 mirror thereof, you
2299 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
2300 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
2301 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
2302 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
2303
2304 The public key for @code{hydra.gnu.org} is installed along with Guix, in
2305 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
2306 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
2307 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
2308 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
2309 Then, you can run something like this:
2310
2311 @example
2312 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
2313 @end example
2314
2315 @quotation Note
2316 Similarly, the @file{berlin.guixsd.org.pub} file contains the public key
2317 for the project's new build farm, reachable at
2318 @indicateurl{https://berlin.guixsd.org}.
2319
2320 As of this writing @code{berlin.guixsd.org} is being upgraded so it can
2321 better scale up, but you might want to give it a try. It is backed by
2322 20 x86_64/i686 build nodes and may be able to provide substitutes more
2323 quickly than @code{mirror.hydra.gnu.org}.
2324 @end quotation
2325
2326 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
2327 should change from something like:
2328
2329 @example
2330 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
2331 The following derivations would be built:
2332 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
2333 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
2334 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
2335 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
2336 @dots{}
2337 @end example
2338
2339 @noindent
2340 to something like:
2341
2342 @example
2343 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
2344 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
2345 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
2346 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
2347 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
2348 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
2349 @dots{}
2350 @end example
2351
2352 @noindent
2353 This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
2354 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
2355
2356 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
2357 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
2358 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
2359 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
2360 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
2361 build}, and other command-line tools.
2362
2363 @node Substitute Authentication
2364 @subsection Substitute Authentication
2365
2366 @cindex digital signatures
2367 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
2368 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
2369 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
2370
2371 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
2372 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
2373 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
2374 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
2375 with this option:
2376
2377 @example
2378 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
2379 @end example
2380
2381 @noindent
2382 @cindex reproducible builds
2383 If the ACL contains only the key for @code{b.example.org}, and if
2384 @code{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
2385 then Guix will download substitutes from @code{a.example.org} because it
2386 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
2387 @code{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
2388 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
2389 below).
2390
2391 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
2392 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
2393 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
2394 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
2395 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
2396 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
2397
2398 @node Proxy Settings
2399 @subsection Proxy Settings
2400
2401 @vindex http_proxy
2402 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
2403 The @code{http_proxy} environment
2404 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
2405 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
2406 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
2407 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
2408 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
2409
2410 @node Substitution Failure
2411 @subsection Substitution Failure
2412
2413 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
2414 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
2415 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
2416 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
2417 etc.
2418
2419 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
2420 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
2421 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
2422 @code{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
2423 option @code{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @code{--fallback} was
2424 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
2425 considered to have failed. However, if @code{--fallback} was given,
2426 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
2427 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
2428 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
2429 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
2430 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
2431 @code{--fallback} was given.
2432
2433 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
2434 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
2435 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
2436 by a server.
2437
2438 @node On Trusting Binaries
2439 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
2440
2441 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
2442 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
2443 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
2444 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
2445 weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
2446 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
2447 their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
2448 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
2449 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
2450 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
2451
2452 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
2453 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
2454 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
2455 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
2456 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
2457 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
2458 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
2459 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
2460 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
2461 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
2462 @command{guix build --check}}).
2463
2464 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
2465 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
2466 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
2467
2468 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
2469 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
2470
2471 @cindex multiple-output packages
2472 @cindex package outputs
2473 @cindex outputs
2474
2475 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
2476 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
2477 @command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
2478 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
2479 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
2480 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
2481 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
2482 files.
2483
2484 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
2485 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
2486 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
2487 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
2488 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
2489 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
2490 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
2491
2492 @example
2493 guix package -i glib
2494 @end example
2495
2496 @cindex documentation
2497 The command to install its documentation is:
2498
2499 @example
2500 guix package -i glib:doc
2501 @end example
2502
2503 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
2504 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
2505 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
2506 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
2507 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
2508 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
2509 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
2510 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
2511 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
2512
2513 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
2514 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
2515 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
2516 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
2517 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
2518 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
2519 guix package}).
2520
2521
2522 @node Invoking guix gc
2523 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
2524
2525 @cindex garbage collector
2526 @cindex disk space
2527 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
2528 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
2529 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
2530 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
2531 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
2532
2533 @cindex GC roots
2534 @cindex garbage collector roots
2535 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
2536 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
2537 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
2538 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
2539 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
2540 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
2541 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
2542 guix build}).
2543
2544 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
2545 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
2546 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
2547 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
2548 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2549
2550 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
2551 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
2552 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
2553
2554 @example
2555 guix gc -F 5G
2556 @end example
2557
2558 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
2559 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job on
2560 GuixSD). Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
2561 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
2562 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
2563 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
2564 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
2565
2566 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
2567 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
2568 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
2569 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
2570 options are as follows:
2571
2572 @table @code
2573 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
2574 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
2575 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
2576 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
2577 specified.
2578
2579 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
2580 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
2581 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
2582 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
2583
2584 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
2585
2586 @item --free-space=@var{free}
2587 @itemx -F @var{free}
2588 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
2589 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
2590 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
2591
2592 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
2593 nothing and exit immediately.
2594
2595 @item --delete
2596 @itemx -d
2597 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
2598 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
2599 they are still live.
2600
2601 @item --list-failures
2602 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
2603
2604 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
2605 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2606 @option{--cache-failures}}).
2607
2608 @item --clear-failures
2609 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
2610
2611 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
2612 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
2613
2614 @item --list-dead
2615 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
2616 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
2617
2618 @item --list-live
2619 Show the list of live store files and directories.
2620
2621 @end table
2622
2623 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
2624
2625 @table @code
2626
2627 @item --references
2628 @itemx --referrers
2629 @cindex package dependencies
2630 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
2631 as arguments.
2632
2633 @item --requisites
2634 @itemx -R
2635 @cindex closure
2636 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
2637 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
2638 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
2639 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
2640
2641 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
2642 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
2643 the graph of references.
2644
2645 @item --derivers
2646 @cindex derivation
2647 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
2648 (@pxref{Derivations}).
2649
2650 For example, this command:
2651
2652 @example
2653 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
2654 @end example
2655
2656 @noindent
2657 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
2658 installed in your profile.
2659
2660 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
2661 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
2662 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
2663 @end table
2664
2665 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
2666 store and to control disk usage.
2667
2668 @table @option
2669
2670 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
2671 @cindex integrity, of the store
2672 @cindex integrity checking
2673 Verify the integrity of the store.
2674
2675 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
2676 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
2677
2678 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
2679 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
2680
2681 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
2682 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
2683 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
2684 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
2685 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
2686
2687 @cindex repairing the store
2688 @cindex corruption, recovering from
2689 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
2690 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
2691 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
2692 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
2693 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
2694 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
2695 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
2696
2697 @item --optimize
2698 @cindex deduplication
2699 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
2700 @dfn{deduplication}.
2701
2702 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
2703 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
2704 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
2705 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
2706 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
2707
2708 @end table
2709
2710 @node Invoking guix pull
2711 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
2712
2713 @cindex upgrading Guix
2714 @cindex updating Guix
2715 @cindex @command{guix pull}
2716 @cindex pull
2717 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
2718 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
2719 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
2720 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
2721 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
2722 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository.
2723
2724 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
2725 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
2726 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
2727 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
2728 become available.
2729
2730 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
2731 effect is limited to the user who run @command{guix pull}. For
2732 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
2733 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
2734 versa@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates the
2735 @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest Guix,
2736 and the @command{guix} command loads code from there. Currently, the
2737 only way to roll back an invocation of @command{guix pull} is to
2738 manually update this symlink to point to the previous Guix.}.
2739
2740 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
2741 but it supports the following options:
2742
2743 @table @code
2744 @item --verbose
2745 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
2746
2747 @item --url=@var{url}
2748 Download Guix from the Git repository at @var{url}.
2749
2750 @vindex GUIX_PULL_URL
2751 By default, the source is taken from its canonical Git repository at
2752 @code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix. To use a different source,
2753 set the @code{GUIX_PULL_URL} environment variable.
2754
2755 @item --commit=@var{commit}
2756 Deploy @var{commit}, a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
2757 string.
2758
2759 @item --branch=@var{branch}
2760 Deploy the tip of @var{branch}, the name of a Git branch available on
2761 the repository at @var{url}.
2762
2763 @item --bootstrap
2764 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
2765 useful to Guix developers.
2766 @end table
2767
2768 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
2769 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
2770
2771 @node Invoking guix pack
2772 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
2773
2774 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
2775 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
2776 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
2777 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
2778
2779 @quotation Note
2780 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
2781 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
2782 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
2783 @end quotation
2784
2785 @cindex pack
2786 @cindex bundle
2787 @cindex application bundle
2788 @cindex software bundle
2789 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
2790 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
2791 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
2792 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
2793 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
2794 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
2795 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
2796 that you pretend to be shipping.
2797
2798 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
2799 their dependencies, you can run:
2800
2801 @example
2802 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
2803 @dots{}
2804 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
2805 @end example
2806
2807 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
2808 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
2809 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
2810 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
2811 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
2812 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
2813
2814 Users of this pack would have to run
2815 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
2816 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
2817 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
2818
2819 @example
2820 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
2821 @end example
2822
2823 @noindent
2824 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
2825
2826 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
2827 the following command:
2828
2829 @example
2830 guix pack -f docker guile emacs geiser
2831 @end example
2832
2833 @noindent
2834 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
2835 command. See the
2836 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
2837 documentation} for more information.
2838
2839 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
2840
2841 @table @code
2842 @item --format=@var{format}
2843 @itemx -f @var{format}
2844 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
2845
2846 The available formats are:
2847
2848 @table @code
2849 @item tarball
2850 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
2851 specified binaries and symlinks.
2852
2853 @item docker
2854 This produces a tarball that follows the
2855 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
2856 Docker Image Specification}.
2857 @end table
2858
2859 @item --expression=@var{expr}
2860 @itemx -e @var{expr}
2861 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
2862
2863 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
2864 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @code{--expression} in
2865 @command{guix build}}).
2866
2867 @item --manifest=@var{file}
2868 @itemx -m @var{file}
2869 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
2870 code in @var{file}.
2871
2872 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
2873 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
2874 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
2875 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
2876 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
2877 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
2878 but not both.
2879
2880 @item --system=@var{system}
2881 @itemx -s @var{system}
2882 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
2883 the system type of the build host.
2884
2885 @item --target=@var{triplet}
2886 @cindex cross-compilation
2887 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
2888 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
2889 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
2890
2891 @item --compression=@var{tool}
2892 @itemx -C @var{tool}
2893 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
2894 @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no compression.
2895
2896 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
2897 @itemx -S @var{spec}
2898 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
2899 appear several times.
2900
2901 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
2902 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
2903 symlink target.
2904
2905 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
2906 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
2907
2908 @item --localstatedir
2909 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the
2910 resulting pack.
2911
2912 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
2913 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
2914 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
2915 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
2916 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
2917
2918 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
2919 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
2920
2921 @item --bootstrap
2922 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
2923 useful to Guix developers.
2924 @end table
2925
2926 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
2927 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
2928 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
2929
2930
2931 @node Invoking guix archive
2932 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
2933
2934 @cindex @command{guix archive}
2935 @cindex archive
2936 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
2937 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
2938 a machine that runs Guix.
2939 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
2940 to the store on another machine.
2941
2942 @quotation Note
2943 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
2944 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
2945 @end quotation
2946
2947 @cindex exporting store items
2948 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
2949
2950 @example
2951 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2952 @end example
2953
2954 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2955 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2956 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2957 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2958 output of @code{emacs}:
2959
2960 @example
2961 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
2962 @end example
2963
2964 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2965 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
2966 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
2967
2968 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
2969 one would run:
2970
2971 @example
2972 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
2973 @end example
2974
2975 @noindent
2976 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2977 to another like this:
2978
2979 @example
2980 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2981 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2982 @end example
2983
2984 @noindent
2985 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2986 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
2987 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
2988 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2989 items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
2990 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
2991 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
2992
2993 @cindex nar, archive format
2994 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
2995 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
2996 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
2997 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
2998 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
2999 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
3000 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
3001 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
3002 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
3003 deterministic.
3004
3005 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
3006 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
3007 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
3008 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
3009 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
3010
3011 The main options are:
3012
3013 @table @code
3014 @item --export
3015 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
3016 resulting archive to the standard output.
3017
3018 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
3019 @code{--recursive} is passed.
3020
3021 @item -r
3022 @itemx --recursive
3023 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
3024 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
3025 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
3026 of the exported store items.
3027
3028 @item --import
3029 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
3030 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
3031 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
3032 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
3033
3034 @item --missing
3035 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
3036 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
3037 the store.
3038
3039 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
3040 @cindex signing, archives
3041 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
3042 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
3043 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
3044 generate the key pair.
3045
3046 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
3047 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
3048 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
3049 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
3050 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
3051 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
3052 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
3053 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
3054 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
3055
3056 @item --authorize
3057 @cindex authorizing, archives
3058 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
3059 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
3060 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
3061
3062 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
3063 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
3064 @url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
3065 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
3066 @url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
3067 (SPKI)}.
3068
3069 @item --extract=@var{directory}
3070 @itemx -x @var{directory}
3071 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
3072 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
3073 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
3074
3075 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
3076 served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
3077
3078 @example
3079 $ wget -O - \
3080 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
3081 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
3082 @end example
3083
3084 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
3085 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
3086 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
3087 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
3088 unsafe.
3089
3090 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
3091 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
3092
3093 @end table
3094
3095 @c *********************************************************************
3096 @node Programming Interface
3097 @chapter Programming Interface
3098
3099 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
3100 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
3101 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
3102 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
3103 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
3104 turned into concrete build actions.
3105
3106 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
3107 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
3108 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
3109 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
3110 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
3111
3112 @cindex derivation
3113 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
3114 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
3115 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
3116 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
3117 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
3118 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
3119 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
3120
3121 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
3122 package definitions.
3123
3124 @menu
3125 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
3126 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
3127 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
3128 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
3129 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
3130 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
3131 @end menu
3132
3133 @node Defining Packages
3134 @section Defining Packages
3135
3136 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
3137 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
3138 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
3139 package looks like this:
3140
3141 @example
3142 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
3143 #:use-module (guix packages)
3144 #:use-module (guix download)
3145 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
3146 #:use-module (guix licenses)
3147 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
3148
3149 (define-public hello
3150 (package
3151 (name "hello")
3152 (version "2.10")
3153 (source (origin
3154 (method url-fetch)
3155 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
3156 ".tar.gz"))
3157 (sha256
3158 (base32
3159 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
3160 (build-system gnu-build-system)
3161 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
3162 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
3163 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
3164 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
3165 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
3166 (license gpl3+)))
3167 @end example
3168
3169 @noindent
3170 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
3171 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
3172 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
3173 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3174 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
3175 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
3176 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
3177
3178 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
3179 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
3180 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
3181
3182 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
3183 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
3184 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
3185 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
3186 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3187
3188 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
3189
3190 @itemize
3191 @item
3192 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
3193 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
3194 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
3195 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
3196
3197 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
3198 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
3199
3200 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
3201 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
3202 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
3203 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
3204 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
3205 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
3206
3207 @cindex patches
3208 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
3209 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
3210 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
3211
3212 @item
3213 @cindex GNU Build System
3214 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
3215 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
3216 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
3217 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
3218 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
3219
3220 @item
3221 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
3222 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
3223 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
3224 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
3225
3226 @cindex quote
3227 @cindex quoting
3228 @findex '
3229 @findex quote
3230 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
3231 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
3232 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
3233 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
3234 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
3235 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
3236 Manual}).
3237
3238 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
3239 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
3240 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
3241 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
3242 Reference Manual}).
3243
3244 @item
3245 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
3246 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
3247 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
3248 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
3249
3250 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
3251 @findex `
3252 @findex quasiquote
3253 @cindex comma (unquote)
3254 @findex ,
3255 @findex unquote
3256 @findex ,@@
3257 @findex unquote-splicing
3258 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
3259 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
3260 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
3261 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
3262 Reference Manual}).
3263
3264 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
3265 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
3266 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
3267
3268 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
3269 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
3270 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
3271 @end itemize
3272
3273 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
3274
3275 Once a package definition is in place, the
3276 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
3277 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
3278 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
3279 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
3280 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
3281 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
3282 more information on how to test package definitions, and
3283 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
3284 for style conformance.
3285 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
3286 Lastly, @pxref{Package Modules}, for information
3287 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
3288 to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
3289
3290 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
3291 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
3292 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
3293
3294 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
3295 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
3296 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
3297 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
3298 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
3299
3300 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
3301 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
3302 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3303
3304 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
3305 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
3306 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
3307 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
3308 (@pxref{The Store}).
3309 @end deffn
3310
3311 @noindent
3312 @cindex cross-compilation
3313 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
3314 package for some other system:
3315
3316 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
3317 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
3318 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
3319 @var{system} to @var{target}.
3320
3321 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
3322 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
3323 (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
3324 Configure and Build System}).
3325 @end deffn
3326
3327 @cindex package transformations
3328 @cindex input rewriting
3329 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
3330 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
3331 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
3332 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
3333
3334 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
3335 [@var{rewrite-name}]
3336 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
3337 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
3338 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
3339 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
3340 is the replacement.
3341
3342 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
3343 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
3344 @end deffn
3345
3346 @noindent
3347 Consider this example:
3348
3349 @example
3350 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
3351 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
3352 ;; recursively.
3353 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
3354
3355 (define git-with-libressl
3356 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
3357 @end example
3358
3359 @noindent
3360 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
3361 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
3362 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
3363 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
3364 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
3365
3366 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
3367 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
3368 graph.
3369
3370 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
3371 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
3372 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
3373 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
3374 @end deffn
3375
3376 @menu
3377 * package Reference :: The package data type.
3378 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
3379 @end menu
3380
3381
3382 @node package Reference
3383 @subsection @code{package} Reference
3384
3385 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
3386 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3387
3388 @deftp {Data Type} package
3389 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
3390
3391 @table @asis
3392 @item @code{name}
3393 The name of the package, as a string.
3394
3395 @item @code{version}
3396 The version of the package, as a string.
3397
3398 @item @code{source}
3399 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
3400 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
3401 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
3402 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
3403 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
3404 @code{local-file}}).
3405
3406 @item @code{build-system}
3407 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
3408 Systems}).
3409
3410 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
3411 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
3412 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
3413
3414 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
3415 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
3416 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
3417 @cindex inputs, of packages
3418 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
3419 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
3420 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
3421 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
3422 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
3423 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
3424 inputs:
3425
3426 @example
3427 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
3428 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
3429 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
3430 @end example
3431
3432 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
3433 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
3434 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
3435 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
3436 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
3437 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
3438
3439 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
3440 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
3441 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
3442 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
3443
3444 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
3445 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
3446 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
3447 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
3448 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
3449 propagated inputs.)
3450
3451 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
3452 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
3453 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
3454
3455 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
3456 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
3457 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
3458 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
3459 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
3460 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
3461
3462 @item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
3463 This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
3464 a native input when cross-compiling.
3465
3466 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
3467 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
3468 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
3469
3470 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
3471 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
3472 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
3473 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
3474
3475 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
3476 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
3477 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
3478 for details.
3479
3480 @item @code{synopsis}
3481 A one-line description of the package.
3482
3483 @item @code{description}
3484 A more elaborate description of the package.
3485
3486 @item @code{license}
3487 @cindex license, of packages
3488 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
3489 or a list of such values.
3490
3491 @item @code{home-page}
3492 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
3493
3494 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
3495 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
3496 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
3497
3498 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
3499 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
3500
3501 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
3502 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
3503 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
3504 automatically corrected.
3505 @end table
3506 @end deftp
3507
3508
3509 @node origin Reference
3510 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
3511
3512 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
3513 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3514
3515 @deftp {Data Type} origin
3516 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
3517
3518 @table @asis
3519 @item @code{uri}
3520 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
3521 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
3522 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
3523 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
3524
3525 @item @code{method}
3526 A procedure that handles the URI.
3527
3528 Examples include:
3529
3530 @table @asis
3531 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
3532 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
3533 @code{uri} field;
3534
3535 @vindex git-fetch
3536 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
3537 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
3538 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
3539 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
3540
3541 @example
3542 (git-reference
3543 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
3544 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
3545 @end example
3546 @end table
3547
3548 @item @code{sha256}
3549 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
3550 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
3551 base-32 string.
3552
3553 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
3554 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
3555 guix hash}).
3556
3557 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
3558 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
3559 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
3560 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
3561 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
3562 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
3563
3564 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
3565 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
3566 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
3567
3568 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
3569 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
3570 @code{%current-target-system}.
3571
3572 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
3573 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
3574 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
3575 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
3576
3577 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
3578 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
3579 command.
3580
3581 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
3582 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
3583 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
3584 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
3585
3586 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
3587 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
3588 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
3589
3590 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
3591 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
3592 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
3593 @end table
3594 @end deftp
3595
3596
3597 @node Build Systems
3598 @section Build Systems
3599
3600 @cindex build system
3601 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
3602 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
3603 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
3604 dependencies of that build procedure.
3605
3606 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
3607 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
3608 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
3609
3610 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
3611 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
3612 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
3613 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
3614 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
3615 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
3616 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
3617
3618 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
3619 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
3620 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
3621 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
3622 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
3623 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
3624 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
3625
3626 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
3627 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
3628 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
3629
3630 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
3631 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
3632 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
3633 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
3634
3635 @cindex build phases
3636 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
3637 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
3638 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
3639 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
3640 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
3641 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
3642
3643 @table @code
3644 @item unpack
3645 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
3646 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
3647 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
3648
3649 @item patch-source-shebangs
3650 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
3651 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
3652 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
3653
3654 @item configure
3655 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
3656 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
3657 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
3658
3659 @item build
3660 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
3661 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
3662 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
3663
3664 @item check
3665 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
3666 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
3667 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
3668 check -j}.
3669
3670 @item install
3671 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
3672
3673 @item patch-shebangs
3674 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
3675
3676 @item strip
3677 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
3678 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
3679 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
3680 @end table
3681
3682 @vindex %standard-phases
3683 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
3684 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
3685 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
3686 procedure implements the actual phase.
3687
3688 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
3689 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
3690
3691 @example
3692 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
3693 @end example
3694
3695 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
3696 @code{configure} phase.
3697
3698 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
3699 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
3700 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
3701 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
3702 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
3703 have to mention them.
3704 @end defvr
3705
3706 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
3707 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
3708 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
3709 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
3710 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
3711
3712 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
3713 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
3714 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
3715 @url{http://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
3716
3717 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
3718 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
3719 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
3720 parameters, respectively.
3721
3722 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
3723 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
3724 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
3725 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
3726 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
3727
3728 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
3729 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
3730 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
3731 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
3732 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
3733 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
3734 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
3735
3736 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
3737 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
3738 ``jar'' task will be run.
3739
3740 @end defvr
3741
3742 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
3743 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
3744 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
3745
3746 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
3747 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
3748 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
3749 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
3750
3751 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
3752 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
3753 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
3754 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
3755 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
3756 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
3757
3758 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
3759 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
3760 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
3761
3762 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
3763 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
3764 the @code{cl-} prefix.
3765
3766 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
3767 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
3768 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
3769 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
3770
3771 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
3772 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
3773 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
3774 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
3775 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
3776 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
3777
3778 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
3779 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
3780 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
3781 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
3782 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
3783 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
3784 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
3785 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
3786
3787 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
3788 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
3789 be used to specify the name of the system.
3790
3791 @end defvr
3792
3793 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
3794 @cindex Rust programming language
3795 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
3796 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
3797 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
3798 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
3799
3800 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system replaces dependencies
3801 specified in the @file{Carto.toml} file with inputs to the Guix package.
3802 The @code{install} phase installs the binaries, and it also installs the
3803 source code and @file{Cargo.toml} file.
3804 @end defvr
3805
3806 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
3807 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
3808 implements the build procedure for packages using the
3809 @url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
3810
3811 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
3812 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
3813 parameter.
3814
3815 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
3816 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
3817 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
3818 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
3819 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
3820 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
3821 @end defvr
3822
3823 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
3824 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
3825 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
3826 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
3827 Go build mechanisms}.
3828
3829 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
3830 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
3831 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
3832 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
3833 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
3834 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
3835 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
3836 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
3837 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
3838 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
3839
3840 Packages that provide Go libraries should be installed along with their
3841 source code. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
3842 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
3843 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
3844 @end defvr
3845
3846 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
3847 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
3848 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
3849
3850 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
3851 @var{gnu-build-system}:
3852
3853 @table @code
3854 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
3855 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
3856 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
3857 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
3858 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
3859 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
3860 environment variables.
3861
3862 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
3863 process by listing their names in the
3864 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
3865 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
3866 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
3867 GLib and GTK+.
3868
3869 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
3870 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
3871 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
3872 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
3873 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
3874 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
3875 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
3876 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
3877 @end table
3878
3879 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
3880 @end defvr
3881
3882 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
3883 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
3884 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
3885
3886 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
3887 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
3888 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
3889 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
3890 output.
3891
3892 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
3893 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
3894 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
3895 @end defvr
3896
3897 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
3898 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
3899 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
3900 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
3901 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
3902 try some of them.
3903
3904 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
3905 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
3906 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
3907 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
3908 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
3909 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
3910 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
3911 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
3912 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
3913
3914 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
3915 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
3916 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
3917 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
3918
3919 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
3920 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
3921 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
3922
3923 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
3924 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
3925 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
3926 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
3927 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
3928 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
3929 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
3930
3931 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
3932 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
3933 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
3934 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
3935 libraries cannot be found and we use @code{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
3936 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
3937 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
3938 @end defvr
3939
3940 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
3941 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
3942 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
3943 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
3944 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
3945
3946 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
3947 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
3948 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
3949
3950 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
3951 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
3952 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
3953 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
3954 interpreter version.
3955
3956 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
3957 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
3958 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
3959 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools} parameter to @code{#f}.
3960 @end defvr
3961
3962 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
3963 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
3964 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
3965 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
3966 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
3967 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
3968 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
3969 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
3970 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
3971 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
3972 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
3973 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
3974
3975 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
3976 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
3977 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
3978
3979 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
3980 @end defvr
3981
3982 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
3983 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
3984 implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
3985 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
3986 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
3987 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
3988 are run after installation using the R function
3989 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
3990 @end defvr
3991
3992 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
3993 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
3994 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
3995 build system sets the @code{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
3996 files in the inputs.
3997
3998 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
3999 different engine and format can be specified with the
4000 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
4001 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
4002 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
4003 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
4004 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
4005 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
4006
4007 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
4008 install the built files under the texmf tree.
4009 @end defvr
4010
4011 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
4012 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
4013 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
4014 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
4015
4016 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
4017 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
4018 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
4019 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
4020 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
4021 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
4022 a traditional source release tarball.
4023
4024 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
4025 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
4026 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
4027 @end defvr
4028
4029 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
4030 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
4031 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
4032 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
4033 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
4034 script.
4035
4036 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
4037 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
4038 @code{#:python} parameter.
4039 @end defvr
4040
4041 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
4042 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
4043 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
4044 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
4045 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
4046 the package.
4047
4048 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
4049 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The version of Python used to run SCons
4050 can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package with the
4051 @code{#:scons} parameter.
4052 @end defvr
4053
4054 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
4055 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
4056 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
4057 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
4058 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
4059 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
4060 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
4061 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
4062 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
4063 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
4064 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
4065 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
4066 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
4067 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
4068
4069 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
4070 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
4071 @end defvr
4072
4073 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
4074 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
4075 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
4076 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
4077 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
4078
4079 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
4080 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
4081 @end defvr
4082
4083 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
4084 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
4085 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
4086 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
4087
4088 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
4089 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
4090 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
4091 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
4092 package is installed in its own directory under
4093 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
4094 @end defvr
4095
4096 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
4097 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
4098 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
4099 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc. font files that merely
4100 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
4101 locations in the output directory.
4102 @end defvr
4103
4104 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
4105 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
4106 implements the build procedure for packages that use
4107 @url{http://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
4108
4109 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
4110 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
4111 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
4112 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
4113 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
4114
4115 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
4116 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
4117
4118 @table @code
4119
4120 @item configure
4121 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
4122 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @code{--build-type} is always set to
4123 @code{plain} unless something else is specified in @code{#:build-type}.
4124
4125 @item build
4126 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
4127 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
4128
4129 @item check
4130 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
4131 which is @code{"test"} by default.
4132
4133 @item install
4134 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
4135 @end table
4136
4137 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
4138
4139 @table @code
4140
4141 @item fix-runpath
4142 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
4143 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
4144 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
4145 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
4146 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
4147 required for the program to run.
4148
4149 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
4150 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
4151 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
4152
4153 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
4154 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
4155 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
4156 @end table
4157 @end defvr
4158
4159 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
4160 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
4161 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
4162 and does not have a notion of build phases.
4163
4164 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
4165 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
4166
4167 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
4168 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
4169 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
4170 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
4171 @end defvr
4172
4173 @node The Store
4174 @section The Store
4175
4176 @cindex store
4177 @cindex store items
4178 @cindex store paths
4179
4180 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
4181 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
4182 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
4183 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
4184 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
4185 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
4186 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
4187 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
4188 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
4189
4190 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
4191 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
4192 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
4193 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
4194
4195 @quotation Note
4196 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
4197 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
4198 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
4199
4200 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
4201 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
4202 accidental modifications.
4203 @end quotation
4204
4205 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
4206 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
4207 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
4208 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
4209 @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
4210
4211 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
4212 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
4213 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
4214 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
4215 supported URI schemes are:
4216
4217 @table @code
4218 @item file
4219 @itemx unix
4220 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
4221 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
4222 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
4223
4224 @item guix
4225 @cindex daemon, remote access
4226 @cindex remote access to the daemon
4227 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
4228 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
4229 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
4230 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
4231 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
4232
4233 @example
4234 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
4235 @end example
4236
4237 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
4238 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
4239 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
4240
4241 The @code{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
4242 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
4243 @code{--listen}}).
4244
4245 @item ssh
4246 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
4247 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over
4248 SSH@footnote{This feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}).}.
4249 A typical URL might look like this:
4250
4251 @example
4252 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
4253 @end example
4254
4255 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
4256 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4257 @end table
4258
4259 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
4260
4261 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
4262 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
4263 @quotation Note
4264 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
4265 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
4266 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
4267 @end quotation
4268 @end defvr
4269
4270 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
4271 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
4272 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
4273 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
4274 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
4275
4276 @var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
4277 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
4278 @end deffn
4279
4280 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
4281 Close the connection to @var{server}.
4282 @end deffn
4283
4284 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
4285 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
4286 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
4287 @end defvr
4288
4289 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
4290 argument.
4291
4292 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
4293 @cindex invalid store items
4294 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
4295 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
4296 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
4297 build.)
4298
4299 A @code{&nix-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
4300 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
4301 @end deffn
4302
4303 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
4304 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
4305 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
4306 resulting store path.
4307 @end deffn
4308
4309 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
4310 Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
4311 derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
4312 Return @code{#t} on success.
4313 @end deffn
4314
4315 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
4316 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
4317 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
4318 Store Monad}).
4319
4320 @c FIXME
4321 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
4322
4323 @node Derivations
4324 @section Derivations
4325
4326 @cindex derivations
4327 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
4328 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
4329 following pieces of information:
4330
4331 @itemize
4332 @item
4333 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
4334 directory in the store, but may produce more.
4335
4336 @item
4337 The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
4338 files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
4339
4340 @item
4341 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
4342
4343 @item
4344 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
4345 to be passed.
4346
4347 @item
4348 A list of environment variables to be defined.
4349
4350 @end itemize
4351
4352 @cindex derivation path
4353 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
4354 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
4355 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
4356 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
4357 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
4358 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
4359 Store}).
4360
4361 @cindex fixed-output derivations
4362 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
4363 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
4364 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
4365 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
4366 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
4367 method and tools being used.
4368
4369 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
4370 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
4371 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
4372 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
4373
4374 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
4375 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
4376 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
4377 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
4378 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
4379 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
4380 [#:substitutable? #t]
4381 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
4382 @code{<derivation>} object.
4383
4384 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
4385 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
4386 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
4387 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
4388 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
4389 containing this output.
4390
4391 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
4392 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
4393 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
4394 a simple text format.
4395
4396 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
4397 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
4398 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
4399 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
4400
4401 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
4402 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
4403 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
4404 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
4405 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
4406 derivations that download files.
4407
4408 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
4409 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
4410 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
4411 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
4412
4413 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
4414 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
4415 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
4416 host CPU instruction set.
4417 @end deffn
4418
4419 @noindent
4420 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
4421 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
4422 to a Bash executable in the store:
4423
4424 @lisp
4425 (use-modules (guix utils)
4426 (guix store)
4427 (guix derivations))
4428
4429 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
4430 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
4431 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
4432 (derivation store "foo"
4433 bash `("-e" ,builder)
4434 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
4435 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
4436 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
4437 @end lisp
4438
4439 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
4440 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
4441 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
4442 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
4443 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
4444
4445 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
4446 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
4447 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
4448 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
4449
4450 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
4451 @var{name} @var{exp} @
4452 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
4453 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
4454 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
4455 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
4456 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
4457 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
4458 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
4459 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
4460 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
4461 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
4462 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
4463 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
4464 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
4465 gnu-build-system))}.
4466
4467 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
4468 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
4469 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
4470 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
4471 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
4472 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
4473 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
4474
4475 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
4476 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
4477 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
4478
4479 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
4480 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
4481 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
4482 @var{substitutable?}.
4483 @end deffn
4484
4485 @noindent
4486 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
4487 containing one file:
4488
4489 @lisp
4490 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
4491 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
4492 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
4493 (lambda (p)
4494 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
4495 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
4496
4497 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
4498 @end lisp
4499
4500
4501 @node The Store Monad
4502 @section The Store Monad
4503
4504 @cindex monad
4505
4506 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
4507 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
4508 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
4509 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
4510
4511 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
4512 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
4513 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
4514 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
4515 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
4516
4517 @cindex monadic values
4518 @cindex monadic functions
4519 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
4520 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
4521 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
4522 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
4523 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
4524 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
4525 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
4526 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
4527 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
4528
4529 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
4530
4531 @example
4532 (define (sh-symlink store)
4533 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
4534 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
4535 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
4536 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
4537 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
4538 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
4539 @end example
4540
4541 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
4542 as a monadic function:
4543
4544 @example
4545 (define (sh-symlink)
4546 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
4547 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
4548 (gexp->derivation "sh"
4549 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
4550 #$output))))
4551 @end example
4552
4553 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
4554 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
4555 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
4556 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
4557 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
4558
4559 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
4560 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
4561 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
4562
4563 @example
4564 (define (sh-symlink)
4565 (gexp->derivation "sh"
4566 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
4567 #$output)))
4568 @end example
4569
4570 @c See
4571 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
4572 @c for the funny quote.
4573 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
4574 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
4575 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
4576 @code{run-with-store}:
4577
4578 @example
4579 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
4580 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
4581 @end example
4582
4583 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
4584 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
4585 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
4586 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
4587
4588 @example
4589 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
4590 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
4591 @end example
4592
4593 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
4594 automatically run through the store:
4595
4596 @example
4597 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
4598 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
4599 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
4600 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
4601 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
4602 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
4603 scheme@@(guile-user)>
4604 @end example
4605
4606 @noindent
4607 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
4608 @code{store-monad} REPL.
4609
4610 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
4611 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
4612
4613 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
4614 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
4615 in @var{monad}.
4616 @end deffn
4617
4618 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
4619 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
4620 @end deffn
4621
4622 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
4623 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
4624 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
4625 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
4626 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
4627 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
4628 in this example:
4629
4630 @example
4631 (run-with-state
4632 (with-monad %state-monad
4633 (>>= (return 1)
4634 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
4635 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
4636 'some-state)
4637
4638 @result{} 4
4639 @result{} some-state
4640 @end example
4641 @end deffn
4642
4643 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
4644 @var{body} ...
4645 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
4646 @var{body} ...
4647 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
4648 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
4649 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
4650 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
4651 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
4652 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
4653 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
4654 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
4655 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
4656 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
4657
4658 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
4659 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
4660 @end deffn
4661
4662 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
4663 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
4664 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
4665 sequence must be a monadic expression.
4666
4667 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
4668 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
4669 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
4670 @end deffn
4671
4672 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
4673 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
4674 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
4675 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
4676 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
4677 @end deffn
4678
4679 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
4680 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
4681 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
4682 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
4683 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
4684 @end deffn
4685
4686 @cindex state monad
4687 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
4688 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
4689 monadic procedure calls.
4690
4691 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
4692 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
4693 the state that is threaded.
4694
4695 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
4696 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
4697 increments the current state value:
4698
4699 @example
4700 (define (square x)
4701 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
4702 (mbegin %state-monad
4703 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
4704 (return (* x x)))))
4705
4706 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
4707 @result{} (0 1 4)
4708 @result{} 3
4709 @end example
4710
4711 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
4712 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
4713 @end defvr
4714
4715 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
4716 Return the current state as a monadic value.
4717 @end deffn
4718
4719 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
4720 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
4721 monadic value.
4722 @end deffn
4723
4724 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
4725 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
4726 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
4727 @end deffn
4728
4729 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
4730 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
4731 The state is assumed to be a list.
4732 @end deffn
4733
4734 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
4735 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
4736 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
4737 @end deffn
4738
4739 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
4740 store)} module, is as follows.
4741
4742 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
4743 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
4744
4745 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
4746 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
4747 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
4748 @end defvr
4749
4750 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
4751 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
4752 open store connection.
4753 @end deffn
4754
4755 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
4756 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
4757 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
4758 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
4759 @end deffn
4760
4761 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
4762 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
4763 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
4764 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
4765 @var{name} is omitted.
4766
4767 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
4768 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
4769 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
4770
4771 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
4772 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
4773 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
4774 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
4775
4776 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
4777
4778 @example
4779 (run-with-store (open-connection)
4780 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
4781 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
4782 (return (list a b))))
4783
4784 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
4785 @end example
4786
4787 @end deffn
4788
4789 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
4790 monadic procedures:
4791
4792 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
4793 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
4794 [#:output "out"]
4795 Return as a monadic
4796 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
4797 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
4798 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
4799 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
4800 @end deffn
4801
4802 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
4803 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
4804 @var{target} [@var{system}]
4805 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
4806 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4807 @end deffn
4808
4809
4810 @node G-Expressions
4811 @section G-Expressions
4812
4813 @cindex G-expression
4814 @cindex build code quoting
4815 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
4816 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
4817 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
4818 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
4819 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
4820
4821 @cindex strata of code
4822 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
4823 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
4824 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
4825 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
4826 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
4827 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
4828 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
4829 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
4830 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
4831 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
4832 @command{make}, etc.
4833
4834 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
4835 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
4836 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
4837 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
4838 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
4839 expressions.
4840
4841 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
4842 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
4843 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
4844 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
4845 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
4846 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
4847 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
4848 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
4849
4850 @itemize
4851 @item
4852 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
4853 processes.
4854
4855 @item
4856 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
4857 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
4858 introduced.
4859
4860 @item
4861 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
4862 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
4863 processes that use them.
4864 @end itemize
4865
4866 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
4867 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
4868 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
4869 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
4870 such that these objects can also be inserted
4871 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
4872 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
4873 add files to the store and to refer to them in
4874 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
4875 below.)
4876
4877 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
4878
4879 @example
4880 (define build-exp
4881 #~(begin
4882 (mkdir #$output)
4883 (chdir #$output)
4884 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
4885 "list-files")))
4886 @end example
4887
4888 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
4889 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
4890 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
4891
4892 @example
4893 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
4894 @end example
4895
4896 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
4897 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
4898 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
4899 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
4900 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
4901 output of the derivation.
4902
4903 @cindex cross compilation
4904 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
4905 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
4906 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
4907 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
4908 native package build:
4909
4910 @example
4911 (gexp->derivation "vi"
4912 #~(begin
4913 (mkdir #$output)
4914 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
4915 "-s"
4916 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
4917 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
4918 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
4919 @end example
4920
4921 @noindent
4922 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
4923 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
4924 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
4925
4926 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
4927 @findex with-imported-modules
4928 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
4929 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
4930 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
4931 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
4932
4933 @example
4934 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
4935 #~(begin
4936 (use-modules (guix build utils))
4937 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
4938 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
4939 #~(begin
4940 #$build
4941 (display "success!\n")
4942 #t)))
4943 @end example
4944
4945 @noindent
4946 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
4947 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
4948 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
4949
4950 @cindex module closure
4951 @findex source-module-closure
4952 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
4953 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
4954 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
4955 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
4956 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
4957 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
4958
4959 @example
4960 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
4961
4962 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
4963 '((guix build utils)
4964 (gnu build vm)))
4965 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
4966 #~(begin
4967 (use-modules (guix build utils)
4968 (gnu build vm))
4969 @dots{})))
4970 @end example
4971
4972 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
4973
4974 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
4975 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
4976 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
4977 or more of the following forms:
4978
4979 @table @code
4980 @item #$@var{obj}
4981 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
4982 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
4983 supported types, for example a package or a
4984 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
4985 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
4986
4987 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
4988 objects are substituted similarly.
4989
4990 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
4991 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
4992
4993 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
4994
4995 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
4996 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
4997 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
4998 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
4999 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5000
5001 @item #+@var{obj}
5002 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
5003 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
5004 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
5005 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
5006 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
5007
5008 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
5009 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
5010 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
5011 output when @var{output} is omitted.
5012
5013 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
5014
5015 @item #$@@@var{lst}
5016 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
5017 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
5018 containing list.
5019
5020 @item #+@@@var{lst}
5021 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
5022 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
5023 @var{lst}.
5024
5025 @end table
5026
5027 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
5028 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
5029 @end deffn
5030
5031 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
5032 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
5033 in their execution environment.
5034
5035 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
5036 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
5037 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
5038
5039 @example
5040 `((guix build utils)
5041 (guix gcrypt)
5042 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
5043 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
5044 @end example
5045
5046 @noindent
5047 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
5048 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
5049
5050 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
5051 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
5052 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
5053 @end deffn
5054
5055 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
5056 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
5057 @end deffn
5058
5059 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
5060 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
5061 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
5062 information about monads.)
5063
5064 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
5065 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
5066 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
5067 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
5068 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
5069 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
5070 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
5071 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
5072 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
5073 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
5074 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
5075 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
5076 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
5077 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
5078 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
5079 to by @var{exp}.
5080
5081 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
5082 Its meaning is to
5083 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
5084 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
5085 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
5086 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
5087 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
5088
5089 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
5090 applicable.
5091
5092 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
5093 following forms:
5094
5095 @example
5096 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
5097 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
5098 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
5099 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
5100 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
5101 @end example
5102
5103 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
5104 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
5105 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
5106 text format.
5107
5108 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
5109 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
5110 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
5111 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
5112 referenced by the outputs.
5113
5114 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
5115 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
5116
5117 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
5118 @end deffn
5119
5120 @cindex file-like objects
5121 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
5122 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
5123 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
5124 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
5125
5126 @example
5127 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
5128 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
5129 @end example
5130
5131 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
5132 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
5133 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
5134 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
5135 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
5136 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
5137 content is directly passed as a string.
5138
5139 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
5140 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
5141 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
5142 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
5143 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
5144 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
5145
5146 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
5147 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
5148 permission bits are kept.
5149
5150 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
5151 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
5152 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
5153 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
5154
5155 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
5156 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
5157 @end deffn
5158
5159 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
5160 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
5161 @var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
5162
5163 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
5164 @end deffn
5165
5166 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
5167 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
5168 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
5169 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
5170 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
5171
5172 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
5173 @end deffn
5174
5175 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
5176 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path]
5177 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
5178 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
5179 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
5180
5181 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
5182 command:
5183
5184 @example
5185 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
5186
5187 (gexp->script "list-files"
5188 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
5189 "ls"))
5190 @end example
5191
5192 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
5193 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
5194 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
5195
5196 @example
5197 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
5198 !#
5199 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
5200 @end example
5201 @end deffn
5202
5203 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
5204 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
5205 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
5206 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
5207 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
5208
5209 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
5210 @end deffn
5211
5212 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
5213 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
5214 [#:guile (default-guile)]
5215 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
5216 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
5217 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
5218 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
5219 @var{module-path}.
5220
5221 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
5222 or a subset thereof.
5223 @end deffn
5224
5225 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
5226 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
5227 @var{exp}.
5228
5229 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
5230 @end deffn
5231
5232 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
5233 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
5234 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
5235 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
5236 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
5237 references to all these.
5238
5239 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
5240 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
5241 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
5242 like this:
5243
5244 @example
5245 (define (profile.sh)
5246 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
5247 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
5248 (text-file* "profile.sh"
5249 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
5250 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
5251 @end example
5252
5253 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
5254 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
5255 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
5259 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
5260 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
5261 as in:
5262
5263 @example
5264 (mixed-text-file "profile"
5265 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
5266 @end example
5267
5268 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
5269 @end deffn
5270
5271 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
5272 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
5273 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
5274 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
5275 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
5276
5277 @example
5278 (file-union "etc"
5279 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
5280 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
5281 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
5282 "alias ls='ls --color'"))))
5283 @end example
5284
5285 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
5286 @end deffn
5287
5288 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
5289 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
5290 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
5291
5292 @example
5293 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
5294 @end example
5295
5296 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
5297 @end deffn
5298
5299 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
5300 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
5301 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
5302 @var{suffix} is a string.
5303
5304 As an example, consider this gexp:
5305
5306 @example
5307 (gexp->script "run-uname"
5308 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
5309 "/bin/uname")))
5310 @end example
5311
5312 The same effect could be achieved with:
5313
5314 @example
5315 (gexp->script "run-uname"
5316 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
5317 "/bin/uname")))
5318 @end example
5319
5320 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
5321 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
5322 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
5323 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
5324 @end deffn
5325
5326
5327 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
5328 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
5329 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
5330 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
5331
5332 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
5333 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
5334 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
5335 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
5336 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
5337
5338 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
5339 [#:target #f]
5340 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
5341 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
5342 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
5343 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
5344 @end deffn
5345
5346
5347 @c *********************************************************************
5348 @node Utilities
5349 @chapter Utilities
5350
5351 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
5352 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
5353 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
5354 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
5355
5356 @menu
5357 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
5358 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
5359 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
5360 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
5361 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
5362 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
5363 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
5364 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
5365 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
5366 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
5367 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
5368 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
5369 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
5370 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
5371 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
5372 @end menu
5373
5374 @node Invoking guix build
5375 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
5376
5377 @cindex package building
5378 @cindex @command{guix build}
5379 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
5380 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
5381 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
5382 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
5383 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
5384
5385 The general syntax is:
5386
5387 @example
5388 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
5389 @end example
5390
5391 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
5392 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
5393 resulting directories:
5394
5395 @example
5396 guix build emacs guile
5397 @end example
5398
5399 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
5400
5401 @example
5402 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
5403 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
5404 @end example
5405
5406 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
5407 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
5408 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
5409 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
5410 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
5411 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5412
5413 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
5414 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
5415 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
5416 needed.
5417
5418 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
5419 described in the subsections below.
5420
5421 @menu
5422 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
5423 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
5424 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
5425 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
5426 @end menu
5427
5428 @node Common Build Options
5429 @subsection Common Build Options
5430
5431 A number of options that control the build process are common to
5432 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
5433 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
5434 following:
5435
5436 @table @code
5437
5438 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
5439 @itemx -L @var{directory}
5440 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
5441 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5442
5443 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
5444 the command-line tools.
5445
5446 @item --keep-failed
5447 @itemx -K
5448 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
5449 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
5450 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
5451 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
5452 build issues.
5453
5454 @item --keep-going
5455 @itemx -k
5456 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
5457 all the builds have either completed or failed.
5458
5459 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
5460 derivations has failed.
5461
5462 @item --dry-run
5463 @itemx -n
5464 Do not build the derivations.
5465
5466 @anchor{fallback-option}
5467 @item --fallback
5468 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
5469 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
5470
5471 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5472 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
5473 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
5474 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
5475 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
5476
5477 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
5478 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
5479 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
5480
5481 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
5482 disabled.
5483
5484 @item --no-substitutes
5485 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
5486 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
5487 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
5488
5489 @item --no-grafts
5490 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
5491 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
5492 information on grafts.
5493
5494 @item --rounds=@var{n}
5495 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
5496 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
5497
5498 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
5499 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
5500 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
5501 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
5502
5503 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
5504 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
5505 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
5506 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
5507 the two results.
5508
5509 @item --no-build-hook
5510 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
5511 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
5512 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
5513
5514 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
5515 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
5516 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
5517
5518 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
5519 guix-daemon, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
5520
5521 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
5522 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
5523 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
5524
5525 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
5526 guix-daemon, @code{--timeout}}).
5527
5528 @item --verbosity=@var{level}
5529 Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
5530 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
5531 may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
5532
5533 @item --cores=@var{n}
5534 @itemx -c @var{n}
5535 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
5536 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
5537
5538 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
5539 @itemx -M @var{n}
5540 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
5541 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
5542 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
5543
5544 @end table
5545
5546 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
5547 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
5548 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
5549 derivations)} module.
5550
5551 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
5552 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
5553 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
5554
5555 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
5556 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
5557 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
5558 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
5559 below:
5560
5561 @example
5562 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
5563 @end example
5564
5565 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
5566 the parsed command-line options.
5567 @end defvr
5568
5569
5570 @node Package Transformation Options
5571 @subsection Package Transformation Options
5572
5573 @cindex package variants
5574 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
5575 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
5576 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
5577 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
5578 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
5579 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
5580 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5581
5582 @table @code
5583
5584 @item --with-source=@var{source}
5585 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
5586 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
5587 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
5588 its version number.
5589 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
5590 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
5591
5592 When @var{package} is omitted,
5593 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
5594 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
5595 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
5596 package is @code{guile}.
5597
5598 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
5599 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
5600
5601 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
5602 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
5603 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
5604 the @code{ed} package:
5605
5606 @example
5607 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
5608 @end example
5609
5610 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
5611 candidates:
5612
5613 @example
5614 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
5615 @end example
5616
5617 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
5618
5619 @example
5620 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
5621 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
5622 @end example
5623
5624 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
5625 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
5626 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
5627 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
5628 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
5629
5630 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
5631 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
5632 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
5633
5634 @example
5635 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
5636 @end example
5637
5638 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
5639 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
5640 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
5641
5642 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
5643 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
5644
5645 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
5646 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
5647 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
5648 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
5649 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
5650 information on grafts.
5651
5652 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
5653 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
5654 they currently refer to:
5655
5656 @example
5657 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
5658 @end example
5659
5660 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
5661 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
5662 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
5663 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
5664 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
5665 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
5666 care!
5667
5668 @end table
5669
5670 @node Additional Build Options
5671 @subsection Additional Build Options
5672
5673 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
5674 build}.
5675
5676 @table @code
5677
5678 @item --quiet
5679 @itemx -q
5680 Build quietly, without displaying the build log. Upon completion, the
5681 build log is kept in @file{/var} (or similar) and can always be
5682 retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
5683
5684 @item --file=@var{file}
5685 @itemx -f @var{file}
5686
5687 Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
5688 evaluates to.
5689
5690 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
5691 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5692
5693 @example
5694 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
5695 @end example
5696
5697 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5698 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5699 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
5700
5701 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
5702 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
5703 version 1.8 of Guile.
5704
5705 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
5706 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
5707 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
5708
5709 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
5710 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
5711 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
5712
5713 @item --source
5714 @itemx -S
5715 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
5716 themselves.
5717
5718 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
5719 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
5720 source tarball.
5721
5722 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
5723 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
5724 Packages}).
5725
5726 @item --sources
5727 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
5728 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
5729 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
5730 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
5731 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
5732 optional argument values:
5733
5734 @table @code
5735 @item package
5736 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
5737 as the @code{--source} option.
5738
5739 @item all
5740 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
5741 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
5742
5743 @example
5744 $ guix build --sources tzdata
5745 The following derivations will be built:
5746 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
5747 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
5748 @end example
5749
5750 @item transitive
5751 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
5752 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g. to
5753 prefetch package source for later offline building.
5754
5755 @example
5756 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
5757 The following derivations will be built:
5758 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
5759 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
5760 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
5761 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
5762 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
5763 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
5764 @dots{}
5765 @end example
5766
5767 @end table
5768
5769 @item --system=@var{system}
5770 @itemx -s @var{system}
5771 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
5772 the system type of the build host.
5773
5774 @quotation Note
5775 The @code{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
5776 be confused with cross-compilation. See @code{--target} below for
5777 information on cross-compilation.
5778 @end quotation
5779
5780 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
5781 different personalities. For instance, passing
5782 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows you
5783 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
5784
5785 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
5786 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
5787 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
5788 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
5789
5790 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
5791 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
5792 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
5793
5794 @item --target=@var{triplet}
5795 @cindex cross-compilation
5796 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
5797 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
5798 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5799
5800 @anchor{build-check}
5801 @item --check
5802 @cindex determinism, checking
5803 @cindex reproducibility, checking
5804 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
5805 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
5806 identical.
5807
5808 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
5809 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
5810 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
5811 background information and tools.
5812
5813 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
5814 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
5815 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
5816
5817 @item --repair
5818 @cindex repairing store items
5819 @cindex corruption, recovering from
5820 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
5821 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
5822
5823 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
5824
5825 @item --derivations
5826 @itemx -d
5827 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
5828 packages.
5829
5830 @item --root=@var{file}
5831 @itemx -r @var{file}
5832 @cindex GC roots, adding
5833 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
5834 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
5835 collector root.
5836
5837 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
5838 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
5839 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
5840 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
5841 more on GC roots.
5842
5843 @item --log-file
5844 @cindex build logs, access
5845 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
5846 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
5847 missing.
5848
5849 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
5850 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
5851
5852 @example
5853 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
5854 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
5855 guix build --log-file guile
5856 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
5857 @end example
5858
5859 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
5860 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
5861 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
5862
5863 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
5864 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
5865
5866 @example
5867 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
5868 https://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
5869 @end example
5870
5871 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
5872 @end table
5873
5874 @node Debugging Build Failures
5875 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
5876
5877 @cindex build failures, debugging
5878 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
5879 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
5880 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
5881 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
5882 build daemon uses.
5883
5884 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
5885 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
5886 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
5887 @code{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--keep-failed}}).
5888
5889 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
5890 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
5891 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
5892 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
5893 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
5894
5895 @example
5896 $ guix build foo -K
5897 @dots{} @i{build fails}
5898 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
5899 $ source ./environment-variables
5900 $ cd foo-1.2
5901 @end example
5902
5903 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
5904 troubleshoot your build process.
5905
5906 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
5907 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
5908 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
5909 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
5910 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
5911
5912 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
5913 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
5914
5915 @example
5916 $ guix build -K foo
5917 @dots{}
5918 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
5919 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
5920 [env]# source ./environment-variables
5921 [env]# cd foo-1.2
5922 @end example
5923
5924 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
5925 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
5926 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
5927 the container, which would may find handy while debugging. The
5928 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
5929 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
5930 info on grafts).
5931
5932 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
5933 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
5934
5935 @example
5936 [env]# rm /bin/sh
5937 @end example
5938
5939 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
5940 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
5941
5942 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
5943 can run:
5944
5945 @example
5946 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
5947 @end example
5948
5949 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
5950 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
5951 similar to the one the daemon uses.
5952
5953
5954 @node Invoking guix edit
5955 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
5956
5957 @cindex @command{guix edit}
5958 @cindex package definition, editing
5959 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
5960 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
5961 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
5962 For instance:
5963
5964 @example
5965 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
5966 @end example
5967
5968 @noindent
5969 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
5970 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
5971 and that of Vim.
5972
5973 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
5974 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5975 (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will be able to edit the package
5976 recipes. Otherwise, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
5977 for packages currently in the store.
5978
5979
5980 @node Invoking guix download
5981 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
5982
5983 @cindex @command{guix download}
5984 @cindex downloading package sources
5985 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
5986 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
5987 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
5988 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
5989 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
5990 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
5991
5992 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
5993 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
5994 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
5995 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
5996 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
5997 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
5998
5999 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
6000 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
6001 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
6002 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
6003 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
6004 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
6005 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
6006
6007 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
6008 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
6009 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
6010 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
6011
6012 The following options are available:
6013
6014 @table @code
6015 @item --format=@var{fmt}
6016 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
6017 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
6018 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
6019
6020 @item --no-check-certificate
6021 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
6022
6023 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
6024 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
6025 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
6026
6027 @item --output=@var{file}
6028 @itemx -o @var{file}
6029 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
6030 store.
6031 @end table
6032
6033 @node Invoking guix hash
6034 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
6035
6036 @cindex @command{guix hash}
6037 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
6038 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
6039 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
6040 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6041
6042 The general syntax is:
6043
6044 @example
6045 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
6046 @end example
6047
6048 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
6049 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
6050 following options:
6051
6052 @table @code
6053
6054 @item --format=@var{fmt}
6055 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
6056 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
6057
6058 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
6059 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
6060
6061 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
6062 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
6063 in the definitions of packages.
6064
6065 @item --recursive
6066 @itemx -r
6067 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
6068
6069 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
6070 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
6071 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
6072 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
6073 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
6074 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
6075 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
6076 @c it exists.
6077
6078 @item --exclude-vcs
6079 @itemx -x
6080 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
6081 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
6082
6083 @vindex git-fetch
6084 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
6085 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
6086 Reference}):
6087
6088 @example
6089 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
6090 $ cd foo
6091 $ guix hash -rx .
6092 @end example
6093 @end table
6094
6095 @node Invoking guix import
6096 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
6097
6098 @cindex importing packages
6099 @cindex package import
6100 @cindex package conversion
6101 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
6102 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
6103 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
6104 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
6105 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
6106 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
6107 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6108
6109 The general syntax is:
6110
6111 @example
6112 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
6113 @end example
6114
6115 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
6116 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
6117 options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
6118 ``importers'' are:
6119
6120 @table @code
6121 @item gnu
6122 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
6123 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
6124 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
6125
6126 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
6127 license needs to be figured out manually.
6128
6129 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
6130 GNU@tie{}Hello:
6131
6132 @example
6133 guix import gnu hello
6134 @end example
6135
6136 Specific command-line options are:
6137
6138 @table @code
6139 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
6140 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
6141 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
6142 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
6143 @end table
6144
6145 @item pypi
6146 @cindex pypi
6147 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
6148 Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
6149 @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
6150 description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
6151 the relevant information, including package dependencies. For maximum
6152 efficiency, it is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so
6153 that the importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
6154
6155 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
6156 package:
6157
6158 @example
6159 guix import pypi itsdangerous
6160 @end example
6161
6162 @item gem
6163 @cindex gem
6164 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
6165 RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
6166 installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
6167 JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
6168 most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
6169 some caveats, however. The metadata doesn't distinguish between
6170 synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
6171 Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
6172 native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
6173 packager.
6174
6175 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
6176
6177 @example
6178 guix import gem rails
6179 @end example
6180
6181 @item cpan
6182 @cindex CPAN
6183 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}@footnote{This
6184 functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
6185 @xref{Requirements}.}.
6186 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
6187 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
6188 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
6189 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
6190 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
6191 list of dependencies.
6192
6193 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
6194 Perl module:
6195
6196 @example
6197 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
6198 @end example
6199
6200 @item cran
6201 @cindex CRAN
6202 @cindex Bioconductor
6203 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
6204 central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
6205 statistical and graphical environment}.
6206
6207 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
6208
6209 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
6210 R package:
6211
6212 @example
6213 guix import cran Cairo
6214 @end example
6215
6216 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
6217 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
6218 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
6219
6220 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
6221 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
6222 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
6223 genomic data in bioinformatics.
6224
6225 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
6226 published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
6227
6228 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
6229 R package:
6230
6231 @example
6232 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
6233 @end example
6234
6235 @item texlive
6236 @cindex TeX Live
6237 @cindex CTAN
6238 Import metadata from @uref{http://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
6239 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
6240 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
6241
6242 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
6243 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
6244 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
6245 versioned archives.
6246
6247 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
6248 TeX package:
6249
6250 @example
6251 guix import texlive fontspec
6252 @end example
6253
6254 When @code{--archive=DIRECTORY} is added, the source code is downloaded
6255 not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the @file{texmf-dist/source}
6256 tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from the specified sibling
6257 directory under the same root.
6258
6259 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
6260 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
6261 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
6262
6263 @example
6264 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
6265 @end example
6266
6267 @item json
6268 @cindex JSON, import
6269 Import package metadata from a local JSON file@footnote{This
6270 functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
6271 @xref{Requirements}.}. Consider the following example package
6272 definition in JSON format:
6273
6274 @example
6275 @{
6276 "name": "hello",
6277 "version": "2.10",
6278 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
6279 "build-system": "gnu",
6280 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
6281 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
6282 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
6283 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
6284 "native-inputs": ["gcc@@6"]
6285 @}
6286 @end example
6287
6288 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
6289 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
6290 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
6291 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
6292
6293 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
6294 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
6295
6296 @example
6297 @{
6298 @dots{}
6299 "source": @{
6300 "method": "url-fetch",
6301 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
6302 "sha256": @{
6303 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
6304 @}
6305 @}
6306 @dots{}
6307 @}
6308 @end example
6309
6310 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
6311 and outputs a package expression:
6312
6313 @example
6314 guix import json hello.json
6315 @end example
6316
6317 @item nix
6318 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
6319 @uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
6320 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
6321 @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
6322 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
6323 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
6324 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
6325 package definition.
6326
6327 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
6328 by their canonical upstream variant.
6329
6330 Usually, you will first need to do:
6331
6332 @example
6333 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
6334 @end example
6335
6336 @noindent
6337 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
6338
6339 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
6340 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
6341 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
6342
6343 @example
6344 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
6345 @end example
6346
6347 @item hackage
6348 @cindex hackage
6349 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
6350 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
6351 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
6352 dependencies.
6353
6354 Specific command-line options are:
6355
6356 @table @code
6357 @item --stdin
6358 @itemx -s
6359 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
6360 @item --no-test-dependencies
6361 @itemx -t
6362 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
6363 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
6364 @itemx -e @var{alist}
6365 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
6366 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
6367 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
6368 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
6369 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
6370 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
6371 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
6372 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
6373 @end table
6374
6375 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
6376 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
6377 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
6378
6379 @example
6380 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
6381 @end example
6382
6383 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
6384 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
6385
6386 @example
6387 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
6388 @end example
6389
6390 @item stackage
6391 @cindex stackage
6392 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
6393 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
6394 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
6395 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
6396 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
6397 GHC compiler used by Guix.
6398
6399 Specific command-line options are:
6400
6401 @table @code
6402 @item --no-test-dependencies
6403 @itemx -t
6404 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
6405 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
6406 @itemx -r @var{version}
6407 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
6408 release is used.
6409 @end table
6410
6411 The command below imports metadata for the @code{HTTP} Haskell package
6412 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
6413
6414 @example
6415 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
6416 @end example
6417
6418 @item elpa
6419 @cindex elpa
6420 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
6421 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6422
6423 Specific command-line options are:
6424
6425 @table @code
6426 @item --archive=@var{repo}
6427 @itemx -a @var{repo}
6428 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
6429 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
6430 are:
6431 @itemize -
6432 @item
6433 @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
6434 identifier. This is the default.
6435
6436 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
6437 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
6438 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
6439 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
6440 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6441
6442 @item
6443 @uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
6444 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
6445
6446 @item
6447 @uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
6448 identifier.
6449 @end itemize
6450 @end table
6451
6452 @item crate
6453 @cindex crate
6454 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
6455 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}.
6456 @end table
6457
6458 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
6459 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
6460 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
6461
6462 @node Invoking guix refresh
6463 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
6464
6465 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
6466 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
6467 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
6468 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
6469 upstream version, like this:
6470
6471 @example
6472 $ guix refresh
6473 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
6474 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
6475 @end example
6476
6477 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
6478 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
6479
6480 @example
6481 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
6482 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
6483 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
6484 @end example
6485
6486 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
6487 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
6488 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
6489 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
6490 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
6491 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
6492 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
6493
6494 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
6495 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
6496 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
6497 to that effect:
6498
6499 @example
6500 (define-public network-manager
6501 (package
6502 (name "network-manager")
6503 ;; @dots{}
6504 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
6505 @end example
6506
6507 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
6508 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
6509 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
6510 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
6511 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
6512 using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
6513 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
6514 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
6515 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
6516 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
6517
6518 The following options are supported:
6519
6520 @table @code
6521
6522 @item --expression=@var{expr}
6523 @itemx -e @var{expr}
6524 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
6525
6526 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
6527
6528 @example
6529 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
6530 @end example
6531
6532 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
6533 the packages.)
6534
6535 @item --update
6536 @itemx -u
6537 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
6538 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
6539 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
6540
6541 @example
6542 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
6543 @end example
6544
6545 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
6546
6547 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
6548 @itemx -s @var{subset}
6549 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
6550 @code{non-core}.
6551
6552 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
6553 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
6554 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
6555 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
6556 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
6557 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
6558
6559 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
6560 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
6561 inconvenient.
6562
6563 @item --manifest=@var{file}
6564 @itemx -m @var{file}
6565 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
6566 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
6567
6568 @item --type=@var{updater}
6569 @itemx -t @var{updater}
6570 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
6571 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
6572
6573 @table @code
6574 @item gnu
6575 the updater for GNU packages;
6576 @item gnome
6577 the updater for GNOME packages;
6578 @item kde
6579 the updater for KDE packages;
6580 @item xorg
6581 the updater for X.org packages;
6582 @item kernel.org
6583 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
6584 @item elpa
6585 the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
6586 @item cran
6587 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
6588 @item bioconductor
6589 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
6590 @item cpan
6591 the updater for @uref{http://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
6592 @item pypi
6593 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
6594 @item gem
6595 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
6596 @item github
6597 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
6598 @item hackage
6599 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
6600 @item stackage
6601 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
6602 @item crate
6603 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
6604 @end table
6605
6606 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
6607 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
6608
6609 @example
6610 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
6611 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
6612 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
6613 @end example
6614
6615 @end table
6616
6617 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
6618 names, as in this example:
6619
6620 @example
6621 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
6622 @end example
6623
6624 @noindent
6625 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
6626 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
6627 effect in this case.
6628
6629 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
6630 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
6631 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
6632 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
6633
6634 @table @code
6635
6636 @item --list-updaters
6637 @itemx -L
6638 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
6639
6640 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
6641 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
6642
6643 @item --list-dependent
6644 @itemx -l
6645 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
6646 result of upgrading one or more packages.
6647
6648 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
6649 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
6650 dependents of a package.
6651
6652 @end table
6653
6654 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
6655 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
6656 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
6657
6658 @example
6659 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
6660 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
6661 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
6662 @end example
6663
6664 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
6665 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
6666
6667 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
6668
6669 @table @code
6670
6671 @item --gpg=@var{command}
6672 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
6673 for in @code{$PATH}.
6674
6675 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
6676 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
6677 of:
6678
6679 @table @code
6680 @item always
6681 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
6682 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
6683
6684 @item never
6685 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
6686
6687 @item interactive
6688 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
6689 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
6690 @end table
6691
6692 @item --key-server=@var{host}
6693 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
6694
6695 @end table
6696
6697 The @code{github} updater uses the
6698 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
6699 releases. When used repeatedly e.g. when refreshing all packages,
6700 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
6701 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
6702 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
6703 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
6704 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
6705 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
6706 otherwise.
6707
6708
6709 @node Invoking guix lint
6710 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
6711
6712 @cindex @command{guix lint}
6713 @cindex package, checking for errors
6714 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
6715 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
6716 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
6717 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
6718 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
6719
6720 @table @code
6721 @item synopsis
6722 @itemx description
6723 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
6724 descriptions and synopses.
6725
6726 @item inputs-should-be-native
6727 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
6728
6729 @item source
6730 @itemx home-page
6731 @itemx mirror-url
6732 @itemx source-file-name
6733 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
6734 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. Check that
6735 the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
6736 just a version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared
6737 @code{file-name} (@pxref{origin Reference}).
6738
6739 @item cve
6740 @cindex security vulnerabilities
6741 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
6742 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
6743 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
6744 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
6745 NIST}.
6746
6747 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
6748
6749 @itemize
6750 @item
6751 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
6752 @item
6753 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
6754 @end itemize
6755
6756 @noindent
6757 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
6758 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
6759
6760 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
6761 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
6762 name and version of the package when they differ from the name that Guix
6763 uses, as in this example:
6764
6765 @example
6766 (package
6767 (name "grub")
6768 ;; @dots{}
6769 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
6770 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2"))))
6771 @end example
6772
6773 @item formatting
6774 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
6775 use of tabulations, etc.
6776 @end table
6777
6778 The general syntax is:
6779
6780 @example
6781 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
6782 @end example
6783
6784 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
6785 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
6786
6787 @table @code
6788 @item --list-checkers
6789 @itemx -l
6790 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
6791 and exit.
6792
6793 @item --checkers
6794 @itemx -c
6795 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
6796 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
6797
6798 @end table
6799
6800 @node Invoking guix size
6801 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
6802
6803 @cindex size
6804 @cindex package size
6805 @cindex closure
6806 @cindex @command{guix size}
6807 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
6808 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
6809 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
6810 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
6811 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
6812 @command{guix size} can highlight.
6813
6814 The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
6815 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
6816 example:
6817
6818 @example
6819 $ guix size coreutils
6820 store item total self
6821 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
6822 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
6823 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
6824 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
6825 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
6826 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
6827 @end example
6828
6829 @cindex closure
6830 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
6831 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
6832 would be returned by:
6833
6834 @example
6835 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
6836 @end example
6837
6838 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
6839 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
6840 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
6841 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
6842 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
6843 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
6844
6845 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
6846 70@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
6847 large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
6848 always available on the system anyway.)
6849
6850 When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
6851 store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
6852 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
6853 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
6854 Coreutils}).
6855
6856 When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
6857 reports information based on the available substitutes
6858 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
6859 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
6860
6861 You can also specify several package names:
6862
6863 @example
6864 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
6865 store item total self
6866 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
6867 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
6868 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
6869 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
6870 @dots{}
6871 total: 102.3 MiB
6872 @end example
6873
6874 @noindent
6875 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
6876 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
6877 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
6878
6879 The available options are:
6880
6881 @table @option
6882
6883 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
6884 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
6885 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
6886
6887 @item --sort=@var{key}
6888 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
6889
6890 @table @code
6891 @item self
6892 the size of each item (the default);
6893 @item closure
6894 the total size of the item's closure.
6895 @end table
6896
6897 @item --map-file=@var{file}
6898 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
6899
6900 For the example above, the map looks like this:
6901
6902 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
6903 produced by @command{guix size}}
6904
6905 This option requires that
6906 @uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
6907 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
6908 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
6909
6910 @item --system=@var{system}
6911 @itemx -s @var{system}
6912 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
6913
6914 @end table
6915
6916 @node Invoking guix graph
6917 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
6918
6919 @cindex DAG
6920 @cindex @command{guix graph}
6921 @cindex package dependencies
6922 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
6923 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
6924 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
6925 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
6926 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
6927 @uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
6928 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
6929 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
6930 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
6931 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
6932 the @uref{http://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language.
6933 The general syntax is:
6934
6935 @example
6936 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
6937 @end example
6938
6939 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
6940 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
6941 dependencies:
6942
6943 @example
6944 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
6945 @end example
6946
6947 The output looks like this:
6948
6949 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
6950
6951 Nice little graph, no?
6952
6953 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
6954 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
6955 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
6956 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
6957 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
6958
6959 @table @code
6960 @item package
6961 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
6962 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
6963 filters out many details.
6964
6965 @item reverse-package
6966 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
6967
6968 @example
6969 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
6970 @end example
6971
6972 ... yields the graph of packages that depend on OCaml.
6973
6974 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
6975 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
6976 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
6977 @option{--list-dependent}}).
6978
6979 @item bag-emerged
6980 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
6981
6982 For instance, the following command:
6983
6984 @example
6985 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
6986 @end example
6987
6988 ... yields this bigger graph:
6989
6990 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
6991
6992 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
6993 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
6994
6995 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
6996 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
6997 here, for conciseness.
6998
6999 @item bag
7000 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
7001 dependencies.
7002
7003 @item bag-with-origins
7004 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
7005
7006 @item derivation
7007 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
7008 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
7009 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
7010 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
7011
7012 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
7013 name instead of a package name, as in:
7014
7015 @example
7016 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
7017 @end example
7018
7019 @item module
7020 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7021 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
7022 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
7023
7024 @example
7025 guix graph -t module guile | dot -Tpdf > module-graph.pdf
7026 @end example
7027 @end table
7028
7029 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
7030 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
7031
7032 @table @code
7033 @item references
7034 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
7035 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
7036
7037 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
7038 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
7039
7040 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
7041 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
7042 (which can be big!):
7043
7044 @example
7045 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
7046 @end example
7047
7048 @item referrers
7049 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
7050 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
7051
7052 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
7053 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
7054 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
7055 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
7056 to it.
7057
7058 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
7059 collected.
7060
7061 @end table
7062
7063 The available options are the following:
7064
7065 @table @option
7066 @item --type=@var{type}
7067 @itemx -t @var{type}
7068 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
7069 the values listed above.
7070
7071 @item --list-types
7072 List the supported graph types.
7073
7074 @item --backend=@var{backend}
7075 @itemx -b @var{backend}
7076 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
7077
7078 @item --list-backends
7079 List the supported graph backends.
7080
7081 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
7082
7083 @item --expression=@var{expr}
7084 @itemx -e @var{expr}
7085 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
7086
7087 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
7088
7089 @example
7090 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
7091 @end example
7092 @end table
7093
7094
7095 @node Invoking guix environment
7096 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
7097
7098 @cindex reproducible build environments
7099 @cindex development environments
7100 @cindex @command{guix environment}
7101 @cindex environment, package build environment
7102 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
7103 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
7104 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
7105 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
7106 environment to use them.
7107
7108 The general syntax is:
7109
7110 @example
7111 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
7112 @end example
7113
7114 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
7115 GNU@tie{}Guile:
7116
7117 @example
7118 guix environment guile
7119 @end example
7120
7121 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
7122 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
7123 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
7124 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
7125 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
7126 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
7127 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
7128 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
7129 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
7130 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
7131 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
7132 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
7133 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
7134 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
7135 details on Bash start-up files.}.
7136
7137 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
7138 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
7139 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
7140 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
7141 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
7142 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
7143
7144 @example
7145 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
7146 then
7147 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
7148 fi
7149 @end example
7150
7151 @noindent
7152 ... or to browse the profile:
7153
7154 @example
7155 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
7156 @end example
7157
7158 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
7159 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
7160 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
7161 and Emacs are available:
7162
7163 @example
7164 guix environment guile emacs
7165 @end example
7166
7167 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
7168 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
7169 command from the rest of the arguments:
7170
7171 @example
7172 guix environment guile -- make -j4
7173 @end example
7174
7175 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
7176 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
7177 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
7178 NumPy:
7179
7180 @example
7181 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
7182 @end example
7183
7184 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
7185 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
7186 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
7187 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
7188 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
7189 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
7190 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
7191 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
7192 additionally includes Git and strace:
7193
7194 @example
7195 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
7196 @end example
7197
7198 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
7199 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
7200 using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
7201 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
7202 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
7203 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
7204 working directory are mounted:
7205
7206 @example
7207 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
7208 @end example
7209
7210 @quotation Note
7211 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
7212 @end quotation
7213
7214 The available options are summarized below.
7215
7216 @table @code
7217 @item --root=@var{file}
7218 @itemx -r @var{file}
7219 @cindex persistent environment
7220 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
7221 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
7222 register it as a garbage collector root.
7223
7224 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
7225 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
7226
7227 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
7228 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
7229 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
7230 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
7231 gc}, for more on GC roots.
7232
7233 @item --expression=@var{expr}
7234 @itemx -e @var{expr}
7235 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
7236 @var{expr} evaluates to.
7237
7238 For example, running:
7239
7240 @example
7241 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
7242 @end example
7243
7244 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
7245 PETSc package.
7246
7247 Running:
7248
7249 @example
7250 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
7251 @end example
7252
7253 starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
7254
7255 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
7256 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
7257
7258 @example
7259 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
7260 @end example
7261
7262 @item --load=@var{file}
7263 @itemx -l @var{file}
7264 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
7265 within @var{file} evaluates to.
7266
7267 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
7268 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
7269
7270 @example
7271 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
7272 @end example
7273
7274 @item --manifest=@var{file}
7275 @itemx -m @var{file}
7276 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
7277 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
7278
7279 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
7280 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
7281 manifest files.
7282
7283 @item --ad-hoc
7284 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
7285 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
7286 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
7287 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
7288
7289 For instance, the command:
7290
7291 @example
7292 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
7293 @end example
7294
7295 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
7296 available.
7297
7298 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
7299 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
7300 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
7301 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
7302
7303 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
7304 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
7305 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
7306 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
7307 that will be added to the environment directly.
7308
7309 @item --pure
7310 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
7311 This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
7312 only contain package inputs.
7313
7314 @item --search-paths
7315 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
7316 environment.
7317
7318 @item --system=@var{system}
7319 @itemx -s @var{system}
7320 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
7321
7322 @item --container
7323 @itemx -C
7324 @cindex container
7325 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
7326 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
7327 Additionally, unless overridden with @code{--user}, a dummy home
7328 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
7329 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly. The spawned process runs
7330 as the current user outside the container, but has root privileges in
7331 the context of the container.
7332
7333 @item --network
7334 @itemx -N
7335 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
7336 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
7337 device.
7338
7339 @item --link-profile
7340 @itemx -P
7341 For containers, link the environment profile to
7342 @file{~/.guix-profile} within the container. This is equivalent to
7343 running the command @command{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile}
7344 within the container. Linking will fail and abort the environment if
7345 the directory already exists, which will certainly be the case if
7346 @command{guix environment} was invoked in the user's home directory.
7347
7348 Certain packages are configured to look in
7349 @code{~/.guix-profile} for configuration files and data;@footnote{For
7350 example, the @code{fontconfig} package inspects
7351 @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts} for additional fonts.}
7352 @code{--link-profile} allows these programs to behave as expected within
7353 the environment.
7354
7355 @item --user=@var{user}
7356 @itemx -u @var{user}
7357 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
7358 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
7359 contain the name @var{user}; the home directory will be
7360 @file{/home/USER}; and no user GECOS data will be copied. @var{user}
7361 need not exist on the system.
7362
7363 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @code{--share} and
7364 @code{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
7365 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
7366 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
7367
7368 @example
7369 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
7370 cd $HOME/wd
7371 guix environment --container --user=foo \
7372 --expose=$HOME/test \
7373 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
7374 @end example
7375
7376 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
7377 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
7378 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
7379
7380 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
7381 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
7382 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
7383 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
7384 point in the container.
7385
7386 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
7387 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
7388 directory:
7389
7390 @example
7391 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
7392 @end example
7393
7394 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
7395 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
7396 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
7397 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
7398 point in the container.
7399
7400 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
7401 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
7402 @file{/exchange} directory:
7403
7404 @example
7405 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
7406 @end example
7407 @end table
7408
7409 @command{guix environment}
7410 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
7411 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
7412
7413
7414 @node Invoking guix publish
7415 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
7416
7417 @cindex @command{guix publish}
7418 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
7419 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
7420 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7421
7422 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
7423 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
7424 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
7425 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
7426 the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
7427
7428 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
7429 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
7430 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
7431 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
7432 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
7433
7434 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
7435 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
7436 guix archive}).
7437
7438 The general syntax is:
7439
7440 @example
7441 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
7442 @end example
7443
7444 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
7445 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
7446
7447 @example
7448 guix publish
7449 @end example
7450
7451 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
7452 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
7453
7454 @example
7455 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
7456 @end example
7457
7458 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
7459 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
7460 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
7461 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
7462 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
7463 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
7464 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
7465
7466 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
7467 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
7468 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
7469 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
7470 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
7471 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
7472
7473 @example
7474 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
7475 @end example
7476
7477 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
7478 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
7479
7480 @cindex build logs, publication
7481 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
7482
7483 @example
7484 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
7485 @end example
7486
7487 @noindent
7488 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
7489 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
7490 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
7491 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
7492 running @command{guix-daemon} with @code{--log-compression=gzip} since
7493 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
7494 bzip2 compression.
7495
7496 The following options are available:
7497
7498 @table @code
7499 @item --port=@var{port}
7500 @itemx -p @var{port}
7501 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
7502
7503 @item --listen=@var{host}
7504 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
7505 accept connections from any interface.
7506
7507 @item --user=@var{user}
7508 @itemx -u @var{user}
7509 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
7510 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
7511
7512 @item --compression[=@var{level}]
7513 @itemx -C [@var{level}]
7514 Compress data using the given @var{level}. When @var{level} is zero,
7515 disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds to different gzip
7516 compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best (CPU-intensive).
7517 The default is 3.
7518
7519 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
7520 the compressed streams are not
7521 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
7522 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
7523 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
7524 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
7525 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
7526 to its responses.
7527
7528 @item --cache=@var{directory}
7529 @itemx -c @var{directory}
7530 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
7531 and only serve archives that are in cache.
7532
7533 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
7534 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
7535 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
7536 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
7537 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
7538 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
7539 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
7540
7541 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
7542 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
7543 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
7544 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
7545 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
7546 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
7547 the best possible bandwidth.
7548
7549 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
7550 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
7551 @option{--workers} below.
7552
7553 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
7554 when they have expired.
7555
7556 @item --workers=@var{N}
7557 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
7558 threads to ``bake'' archives.
7559
7560 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
7561 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
7562 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
7563 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
7564
7565 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
7566 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
7567 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
7568 for as long as @var{ttl}.
7569
7570 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
7571 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
7572 item in the store, may be deleted.
7573
7574 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
7575 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
7576 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
7577
7578 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
7579 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
7580 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
7581
7582 @item --public-key=@var{file}
7583 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
7584 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
7585 the store items being published.
7586
7587 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
7588 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
7589 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
7590 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
7591 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
7592 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
7593
7594 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
7595 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
7596 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
7597 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
7598 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
7599 @end table
7600
7601 Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
7602 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
7603 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
7604 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
7605
7606 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
7607 instructions:”
7608
7609 @itemize
7610 @item
7611 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
7612
7613 @example
7614 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
7615 /etc/systemd/system/
7616 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
7617 @end example
7618
7619 @item
7620 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
7621
7622 @example
7623 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
7624 # start guix-publish
7625 @end example
7626
7627 @item
7628 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
7629 @end itemize
7630
7631 @node Invoking guix challenge
7632 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
7633
7634 @cindex reproducible builds
7635 @cindex verifiable builds
7636 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
7637 @cindex challenge
7638 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
7639 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
7640 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
7641 answer.
7642
7643 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
7644 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
7645 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
7646 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
7647 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
7648 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
7649 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
7650
7651 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
7652 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
7653 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
7654 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
7655 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
7656 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
7657 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
7658 any given store item.
7659
7660 The command output looks like this:
7661
7662 @smallexample
7663 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://hydra.gnu.org https://guix.example.org"
7664 updating list of substitutes from 'https://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
7665 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
7666 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
7667 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
7668 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
7669 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
7670 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
7671 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
7672 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
7673 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
7674 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
7675 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
7676 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
7677 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
7678
7679 @dots{}
7680
7681 6,406 store items were analyzed:
7682 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
7683 - 525 (8.2%) differed
7684 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
7685 @end smallexample
7686
7687 @noindent
7688 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
7689 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
7690 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
7691 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
7692 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
7693
7694 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
7695 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
7696 Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
7697 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
7698 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
7699 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
7700 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
7701 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
7702 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
7703 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
7704 more information.
7705
7706 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
7707 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
7708
7709 @example
7710 $ wget -q -O - https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
7711 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
7712 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
7713 @end example
7714
7715 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
7716 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
7717 @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
7718 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
7719 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
7720 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
7721 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
7722
7723 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
7724 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
7725 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
7726 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
7727 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
7728 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
7729 the problem.
7730
7731 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
7732 whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
7733 same build result as you did with:
7734
7735 @example
7736 $ guix challenge @var{package}
7737 @end example
7738
7739 @noindent
7740 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
7741 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
7742
7743 The general syntax is:
7744
7745 @example
7746 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
7747 @end example
7748
7749 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
7750 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
7751 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
7752 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
7753 errors.)
7754
7755 The one option that matters is:
7756
7757 @table @code
7758
7759 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
7760 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
7761 URLs to compare to.
7762
7763 @item --verbose
7764 @itemx -v
7765 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
7766 information about mismatches.
7767
7768 @end table
7769
7770 @node Invoking guix copy
7771 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
7772
7773 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
7774 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
7775 @cindex sharing store items across machines
7776 @cindex transferring store items across machines
7777 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
7778 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
7779 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
7780 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
7781 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
7782 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
7783
7784 @example
7785 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
7786 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
7787 @end example
7788
7789 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
7790 they are not actually sent.
7791
7792 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
7793 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
7794
7795 @example
7796 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
7797 @end example
7798
7799 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
7800 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
7801 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
7802
7803 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
7804 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
7805 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
7806 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
7807 store item authentication.
7808
7809 The general syntax is:
7810
7811 @example
7812 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
7813 @end example
7814
7815 You must always specify one of the following options:
7816
7817 @table @code
7818 @item --to=@var{spec}
7819 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
7820 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
7821 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
7822 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
7823 @end table
7824
7825 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
7826 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
7827
7828 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
7829 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
7830 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
7831
7832
7833 @node Invoking guix container
7834 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
7835 @cindex container
7836 @cindex @command{guix container}
7837 @quotation Note
7838 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
7839 is subject to radical change in the future.
7840 @end quotation
7841
7842 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
7843 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
7844 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
7845 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
7846 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
7847
7848 The general syntax is:
7849
7850 @example
7851 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
7852 @end example
7853
7854 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
7855 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
7856
7857 The following actions are available:
7858
7859 @table @code
7860 @item exec
7861 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
7862
7863 The syntax is:
7864
7865 @example
7866 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
7867 @end example
7868
7869 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
7870 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
7871 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
7872 will be passed to @var{program}.
7873
7874 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
7875 GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
7876 process ID is 9001:
7877
7878 @example
7879 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
7880 @end example
7881
7882 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
7883 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
7884
7885 @end table
7886
7887 @node Invoking guix weather
7888 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
7889
7890 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
7891 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
7892 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
7893 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
7894 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
7895 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
7896 publish}).
7897
7898 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
7899 @cindex availability of substitutes
7900 @cindex substitute availability
7901 @cindex weather, substitute availability
7902 Here's a sample run:
7903
7904 @example
7905 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
7906 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
7907 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
7908 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
7909 https://guix.example.org
7910 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
7911 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
7912 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
7913 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
7914 33.5 requests per second
7915
7916 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
7917 867 queued builds
7918 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
7919 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
7920 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
7921 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
7922 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
7923 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
7924 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
7925 @end example
7926
7927 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
7928 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
7929 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
7930 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
7931 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
7932 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
7933 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
7934 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
7935 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it.
7936
7937 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
7938 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
7939 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
7940 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
7941 those substitutes.
7942
7943 Among other things, it is possible to query specific system types and
7944 specific package sets. The available options are listed below.
7945
7946 @table @code
7947 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
7948 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
7949 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
7950 servers is queried.
7951
7952 @item --system=@var{system}
7953 @itemx -s @var{system}
7954 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
7955 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
7956 substitutes for several system types.
7957
7958 @item --manifest=@var{file}
7959 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
7960 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
7961 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
7962 guix package}).
7963 @end table
7964
7965
7966 @c *********************************************************************
7967 @node GNU Distribution
7968 @chapter GNU Distribution
7969
7970 @cindex Guix System Distribution
7971 @cindex GuixSD
7972 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
7973 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
7974 @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
7975 users of that software}.}. The
7976 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
7977 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
7978 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
7979 between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
7980 System Distribution, or GuixSD.
7981
7982 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
7983 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
7984 list of available packages can be browsed
7985 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
7986 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
7987
7988 @example
7989 guix package --list-available
7990 @end example
7991
7992 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
7993 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
7994 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
7995 tools that help users exert that freedom.
7996
7997 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
7998
7999 @table @code
8000
8001 @item x86_64-linux
8002 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
8003
8004 @item i686-linux
8005 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
8006
8007 @item armhf-linux
8008 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
8009 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
8010 and Linux-Libre kernel.
8011
8012 @item aarch64-linux
8013 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel. This is
8014 currently in an experimental stage, with limited support.
8015 @xref{Contributing}, for how to help!
8016
8017 @item mips64el-linux
8018 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
8019 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
8020
8021 @end table
8022
8023 GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
8024
8025 @noindent
8026 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
8027 @pxref{Porting}.
8028
8029 @menu
8030 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
8031 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
8032 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
8033 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
8034 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
8035 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
8036 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
8037 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
8038 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
8039 @end menu
8040
8041 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
8042 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
8043
8044 @node System Installation
8045 @section System Installation
8046
8047 @cindex installing GuixSD
8048 @cindex Guix System Distribution
8049 This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD)
8050 on a machine. The Guix package manager can
8051 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
8052 @pxref{Installation}.
8053
8054 @ifinfo
8055 @quotation Note
8056 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
8057 @c installation image.
8058 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
8059 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
8060 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
8061 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
8062
8063 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
8064 available.
8065 @end quotation
8066 @end ifinfo
8067
8068 @menu
8069 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
8070 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
8071 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
8072 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
8073 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
8074 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
8075 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
8076 @end menu
8077
8078 @node Limitations
8079 @subsection Limitations
8080
8081 As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
8082 not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
8083 features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
8084 respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
8085 is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
8086 the more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
8087 to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
8088 also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
8089 of it (@pxref{Installation}).
8090
8091 Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
8092 noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
8093
8094 @itemize
8095 @item
8096 The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
8097 requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
8098 get a feel of what that means.)
8099
8100 @item
8101 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
8102
8103 @item
8104 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
8105 may be missing.
8106
8107 @item
8108 More than 6,500 packages are available, but you might
8109 occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
8110
8111 @item
8112 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
8113 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, some graphical
8114 applications may be missing, as well as KDE.
8115 @end itemize
8116
8117 You have been warned! But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
8118 to report issues (and success stories!), and to join us in improving it.
8119 @xref{Contributing}, for more info.
8120
8121
8122 @node Hardware Considerations
8123 @subsection Hardware Considerations
8124
8125 @cindex hardware support on GuixSD
8126 GNU@tie{}GuixSD focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
8127 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
8128 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
8129 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
8130 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
8131 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
8132 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
8133 hardware is not supported on GuixSD.
8134
8135 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
8136 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
8137 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
8138 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
8139 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
8140 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
8141 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
8142 out-of-the-box on GuixSD, as part of @var{%base-firmware}
8143 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
8144
8145 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
8146 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
8147 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
8148 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
8149 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
8150 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
8151
8152 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
8153 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
8154 about their support in GNU/Linux.
8155
8156
8157 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
8158 @subsection USB Stick and DVD Installation
8159
8160 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
8161 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
8162 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz},
8163 where @var{system} is one of:
8164
8165 @table @code
8166 @item x86_64-linux
8167 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
8168
8169 @item i686-linux
8170 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
8171 @end table
8172
8173 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
8174 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
8175 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
8176
8177 @example
8178 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
8179 $ gpg --verify guixsd-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
8180 @end example
8181
8182 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
8183 then run this command to import it:
8184
8185 @example
8186 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
8187 @end example
8188
8189 @noindent
8190 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
8191 @c end duplication
8192
8193 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
8194 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
8195
8196 @unnumberedsubsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
8197
8198 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
8199
8200 @enumerate
8201 @item
8202 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
8203
8204 @example
8205 xz -d guixsd-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
8206 @end example
8207
8208 @item
8209 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
8210 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
8211 copy the image with:
8212
8213 @example
8214 dd if=guixsd-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso of=/dev/sdX
8215 sync
8216 @end example
8217
8218 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
8219 @end enumerate
8220
8221 @unnumberedsubsubsec Burning on a DVD
8222
8223 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
8224
8225 @enumerate
8226 @item
8227 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
8228
8229 @example
8230 xz -d guixsd-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
8231 @end example
8232
8233 @item
8234 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
8235 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
8236 copy the image with:
8237
8238 @example
8239 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guixsd-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64.iso
8240 @end example
8241
8242 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
8243 @end enumerate
8244
8245 @unnumberedsubsubsec Booting
8246
8247 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
8248 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
8249 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
8250
8251 @xref{Installing GuixSD in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
8252 GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM).
8253
8254
8255 @node Preparing for Installation
8256 @subsection Preparing for Installation
8257
8258 Once you have successfully booted your computer using the installation medium,
8259 you should end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured
8260 and can be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
8261 browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
8262 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse
8263 daemon, which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and
8264 to paste it with the middle button.
8265
8266 @quotation Note
8267 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
8268 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
8269 ``Networking'' section below.
8270 @end quotation
8271
8272 The installation system includes many common tools needed for this task.
8273 But it is also a full-blown GuixSD system, which means that you can
8274 install additional packages, should you need it, using @command{guix
8275 package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
8276
8277 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
8278
8279 @cindex keyboard layout
8280 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
8281 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
8282 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
8283
8284 @example
8285 loadkeys dvorak
8286 @end example
8287
8288 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
8289 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
8290 more information.
8291
8292 @subsubsection Networking
8293
8294 Run the following command see what your network interfaces are called:
8295
8296 @example
8297 ifconfig -a
8298 @end example
8299
8300 @noindent
8301 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
8302
8303 @example
8304 ip a
8305 @end example
8306
8307 @c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
8308 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
8309 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
8310 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
8311 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
8312
8313 @table @asis
8314 @item Wired connection
8315 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
8316 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
8317
8318 @example
8319 ifconfig @var{interface} up
8320 @end example
8321
8322 @item Wireless connection
8323 @cindex wireless
8324 @cindex WiFi
8325 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
8326 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
8327 important) using one of the available text editors such as
8328 @command{zile}:
8329
8330 @example
8331 zile wpa_supplicant.conf
8332 @end example
8333
8334 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
8335 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
8336 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
8337
8338 @example
8339 network=@{
8340 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
8341 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
8342 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
8343 @}
8344 @end example
8345
8346 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
8347 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
8348 network interface you want to use):
8349
8350 @example
8351 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
8352 @end example
8353
8354 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
8355 @end table
8356
8357 @cindex DHCP
8358 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
8359 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
8360
8361 @example
8362 dhclient -v @var{interface}
8363 @end example
8364
8365 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
8366
8367 @example
8368 ping -c 3 gnu.org
8369 @end example
8370
8371 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
8372 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
8373
8374 @cindex installing over SSH
8375 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
8376 an SSH server:
8377
8378 @example
8379 herd start ssh-daemon
8380 @end example
8381
8382 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
8383 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
8384
8385 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
8386
8387 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
8388 then format the target partition(s).
8389
8390 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
8391 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
8392 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
8393 the partition layout you want:
8394
8395 @example
8396 cfdisk
8397 @end example
8398
8399 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
8400 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
8401 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
8402 manual}).
8403
8404 @cindex EFI, installation
8405 @cindex UEFI, installation
8406 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
8407 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
8408 (ESP) is required. This partition should be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} and
8409 must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
8410
8411 @example
8412 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
8413 @end example
8414
8415 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
8416 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
8417 GuixSD only supports ext4 and btrfs file systems. In particular, code
8418 that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
8419 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
8420 @file{/dev/sda2}, run:
8421
8422 @example
8423 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda2
8424 @end example
8425
8426 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
8427 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
8428 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
8429 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
8430 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda1}, a file system with the label
8431 @code{my-root} can be created with:
8432
8433 @example
8434 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda1
8435 @end example
8436
8437 @cindex encrypted disk
8438 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
8439 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
8440 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
8441 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
8442 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda1}, the command sequence would
8443 be along these lines:
8444
8445 @example
8446 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda1
8447 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda1 my-partition
8448 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
8449 @end example
8450
8451 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
8452 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
8453 root file system):
8454
8455 @example
8456 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
8457 @end example
8458
8459 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
8460 system relative to this path. If you have @file{/boot} on a separate
8461 partition for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot} now so it is found
8462 by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
8463
8464 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
8465 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
8466 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
8467 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, you would run:
8468
8469 @example
8470 mkswap /dev/sda2
8471 swapon /dev/sda2
8472 @end example
8473
8474 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
8475 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
8476 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
8477 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
8478 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
8479 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
8480
8481 @example
8482 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
8483 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
8484 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
8485 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
8486 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
8487 swapon /mnt/swapfile
8488 @end example
8489
8490 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
8491 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
8492 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
8493
8494 @node Proceeding with the Installation
8495 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
8496
8497 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
8498 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
8499
8500 @example
8501 herd start cow-store /mnt
8502 @end example
8503
8504 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
8505 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
8506 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
8507 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
8508 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
8509
8510 Next, you have to edit a file and
8511 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
8512 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors: GNU nano
8513 (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
8514 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
8515 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
8516 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
8517 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
8518
8519 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
8520 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
8521 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
8522 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
8523 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
8524 something along these lines:
8525
8526 @example
8527 # mkdir /mnt/etc
8528 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
8529 # zile /mnt/etc/config.scm
8530 @end example
8531
8532 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
8533 in particular:
8534
8535 @itemize
8536 @item
8537 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
8538 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
8539 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
8540 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
8541 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
8542 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}, and do make sure the
8543 path is actually mounted.
8544
8545 @item
8546 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
8547 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
8548 your @code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
8549 @code{'label}.
8550
8551 @item
8552 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
8553 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
8554 @end itemize
8555
8556 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
8557 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
8558 under @file{/mnt}):
8559
8560 @example
8561 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
8562 @end example
8563
8564 @noindent
8565 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
8566 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
8567 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
8568 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
8569
8570 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
8571 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
8572 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
8573 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
8574 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
8575 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
8576
8577 @cindex upgrading GuixSD
8578 From then on, you can update GuixSD whenever you want by running
8579 @command{guix pull} as @code{root} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}), and
8580 then running @command{guix system reconfigure} to build a new system
8581 generation with the latest packages and services (@pxref{Invoking guix
8582 system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that your system
8583 includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
8584
8585 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
8586 @file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
8587 good.
8588
8589 @node Installing GuixSD in a VM
8590 @subsection Installing GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
8591
8592 @cindex virtual machine, GuixSD installation
8593 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
8594 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
8595 If you'd like to install GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
8596 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
8597 section is for you.
8598
8599 To boot a @uref{http://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing GuixSD in a
8600 disk image, follow these steps:
8601
8602 @enumerate
8603 @item
8604 First, retrieve and decompress the GuixSD installation image as
8605 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
8606
8607 @item
8608 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
8609 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
8610
8611 @example
8612 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 50G
8613 @end example
8614
8615 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
8616 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
8617
8618 @item
8619 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
8620
8621 @example
8622 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 \
8623 -net user -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
8624 -drive file=guixsd-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso \
8625 -drive file=guixsd.img
8626 @end example
8627
8628 The ordering of the drives matters.
8629
8630 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
8631 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
8632 selection.
8633
8634 @item
8635 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
8636 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
8637 @end enumerate
8638
8639 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
8640 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM}, for how to do
8641 that.
8642
8643 @node Building the Installation Image
8644 @subsection Building the Installation Image
8645
8646 @cindex installation image
8647 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
8648 system} command, specifically:
8649
8650 @example
8651 guix system disk-image gnu/system/install.scm
8652 @end example
8653
8654 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
8655 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
8656 about the installation image.
8657
8658 @node System Configuration
8659 @section System Configuration
8660
8661 @cindex system configuration
8662 The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
8663 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
8664 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
8665 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
8666 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
8667
8668 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
8669 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
8670 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
8671 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
8672 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
8673 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
8674 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
8675 the own tools of the system.
8676 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
8677
8678 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
8679 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
8680 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
8681 instance to support new system services.
8682
8683 @menu
8684 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
8685 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
8686 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
8687 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
8688 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
8689 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
8690 * Services:: Specifying system services.
8691 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
8692 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
8693 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
8694 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
8695 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
8696 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
8697 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
8698 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
8699 @end menu
8700
8701 @node Using the Configuration System
8702 @subsection Using the Configuration System
8703
8704 The operating system is configured by providing an
8705 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
8706 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
8707 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
8708 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
8709
8710 @findex operating-system
8711 @lisp
8712 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
8713 @end lisp
8714
8715 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
8716 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
8717 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
8718 which case they get a default value.
8719
8720 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
8721 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
8722 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
8723 @command{guix system}.
8724
8725 @unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
8726
8727 @vindex %base-packages
8728 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
8729 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
8730 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
8731 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
8732 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
8733 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
8734 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
8735 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen and OpenSSH to those,
8736 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)} and @code{(gnu packages ssh)}
8737 modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
8738 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
8739 of a package:
8740
8741 @lisp
8742 (use-modules (gnu packages))
8743 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
8744
8745 (operating-system
8746 ;; ...
8747 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
8748 %base-packages)))
8749 @end lisp
8750
8751 @findex specification->package
8752 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
8753 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
8754 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
8755 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
8756 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
8757 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
8758 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
8759 version:
8760
8761 @lisp
8762 (use-modules (gnu packages))
8763
8764 (operating-system
8765 ;; ...
8766 (packages (append (map specification->package
8767 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
8768 %base-packages)))
8769 @end lisp
8770
8771 @unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
8772
8773 @cindex services
8774 @vindex %base-services
8775 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
8776 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
8777 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
8778 addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
8779 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
8780 @code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
8781 @code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
8782 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
8783 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
8784
8785 @cindex customization, of services
8786 @findex modify-services
8787 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
8788 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
8789 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
8790
8791 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
8792 (the console log-in) in the @var{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
8793 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
8794 following in your operating system declaration:
8795
8796 @lisp
8797 (define %my-services
8798 ;; My very own list of services.
8799 (modify-services %base-services
8800 (guix-service-type config =>
8801 (guix-configuration
8802 (inherit config)
8803 (use-substitutes? #f)
8804 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
8805 (mingetty-service-type config =>
8806 (mingetty-configuration
8807 (inherit config)))))
8808
8809 (operating-system
8810 ;; @dots{}
8811 (services %my-services))
8812 @end lisp
8813
8814 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
8815 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
8816 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @var{%base-services} list.
8817 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
8818 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
8819 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
8820 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
8821 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
8822 configuration, but with a few modifications.
8823
8824 @cindex encrypted disk
8825 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
8826 root partition, the X11 display
8827 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
8828 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
8829 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
8830
8831 @lisp
8832 @include os-config-desktop.texi
8833 @end lisp
8834
8835 @cindex UEFI
8836 A graphical UEFI system with a choice of lightweight window managers
8837 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
8838
8839 @lisp
8840 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
8841 @end lisp
8842
8843 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
8844 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
8845 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
8846
8847 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
8848 @var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
8849 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
8850
8851 Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
8852 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
8853 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
8854 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
8855 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
8856 @var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
8857
8858 @example
8859 (remove (lambda (service)
8860 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
8861 %desktop-services)
8862 @end example
8863
8864 @unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
8865
8866 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
8867 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
8868 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
8869 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
8870 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
8871
8872 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
8873 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
8874 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
8875 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
8876 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
8877 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
8878 system, should you ever need to.
8879
8880 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
8881 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
8882 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
8883 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
8884 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
8885 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
8886 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
8887 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
8888 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
8889 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
8890
8891 Although the command @command{guix system reconfigure} will not modify
8892 previous generations, must take care when the current generation is not
8893 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
8894 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
8895 system}).
8896
8897 @unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
8898
8899 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
8900 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
8901 Monad}):
8902
8903 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
8904 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
8905 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
8906
8907 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
8908 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
8909 instantiate @var{os}.
8910 @end deffn
8911
8912 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
8913 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
8914 guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
8915
8916
8917 @node operating-system Reference
8918 @subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
8919
8920 This section summarizes all the options available in
8921 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
8922 System}).
8923
8924 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
8925 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
8926 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
8927 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
8928
8929 @table @asis
8930 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
8931 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
8932 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
8933 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
8934
8935 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
8936 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
8937 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
8938
8939 @item @code{bootloader}
8940 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
8941
8942 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
8943 @cindex initrd
8944 @cindex initial RAM disk
8945 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
8946 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
8947
8948 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
8949 A monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
8950 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
8951 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
8952
8953 @item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
8954 @cindex firmware
8955 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
8956
8957 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
8958 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
8959 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
8960 supported hardware.
8961
8962 @item @code{host-name}
8963 The host name.
8964
8965 @item @code{hosts-file}
8966 @cindex hosts file
8967 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
8968 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
8969 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
8970 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
8971
8972 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
8973 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
8974
8975 @item @code{file-systems}
8976 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
8977
8978 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
8979 @cindex swap devices
8980 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
8981 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
8982 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
8983 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
8984 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
8985 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
8986
8987 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
8988 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
8989 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
8990
8991 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
8992 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
8993
8994 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
8995 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
8996 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
8997 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
8998
8999 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
9000
9001 @example
9002 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
9003 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
9004 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
9005 (activate-readline)")))
9006 @end example
9007
9008 @item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
9009 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
9010 displayed when users log in on a text console.
9011
9012 @item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
9013 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
9014 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
9015
9016 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
9017 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
9018 package}).
9019
9020 @item @code{timezone}
9021 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
9022
9023 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
9024 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
9025 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
9026
9027 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
9028 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
9029 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
9030
9031 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
9032 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
9033 run time. @xref{Locales}.
9034
9035 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
9036 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
9037 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
9038 considerations that justify this option.
9039
9040 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
9041 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
9042 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
9043 details.
9044
9045 @item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
9046 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
9047
9048 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
9049 @cindex PAM
9050 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
9051 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
9052 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
9053
9054 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
9055 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
9056 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
9057
9058 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
9059 @cindex sudoers file
9060 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
9061 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
9062
9063 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
9064 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
9065 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
9066 @code{sudo}.
9067
9068 @end table
9069 @end deftp
9070
9071 @node File Systems
9072 @subsection File Systems
9073
9074 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
9075 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
9076 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
9077 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
9078
9079 @example
9080 (file-system
9081 (mount-point "/home")
9082 (device "/dev/sda3")
9083 (type "ext4"))
9084 @end example
9085
9086 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
9087 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
9088
9089 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
9090 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
9091 contain the following members:
9092
9093 @table @asis
9094 @item @code{type}
9095 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
9096 @code{"ext4"}.
9097
9098 @item @code{mount-point}
9099 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
9100
9101 @item @code{device}
9102 This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
9103 of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
9104 field described below.
9105
9106 @item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
9107 This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
9108 interpreted.
9109
9110 When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
9111 interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
9112 is interpreted as a file system label name; when it is @code{uuid},
9113 @code{device} is interpreted as a file system unique identifier (UUID).
9114
9115 UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
9116 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
9117 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
9118 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
9119 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
9120 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
9121 like this:
9122
9123 @example
9124 (file-system
9125 (mount-point "/home")
9126 (type "ext4")
9127 (title 'uuid)
9128 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
9129 @end example
9130
9131 The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to file
9132 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
9133 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
9134 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
9135 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
9136 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
9137 mounted.}.
9138
9139 However, when the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
9140 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
9141 device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
9142 @code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
9143 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
9144 corresponding device mapping established.
9145
9146 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
9147 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
9148 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
9149 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
9150 bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
9151
9152 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
9153 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
9154
9155 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
9156 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
9157 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
9158 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
9159 is not automatically mounted.
9160
9161 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
9162 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
9163 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
9164 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
9165 instance, for the root file system.
9166
9167 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
9168 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
9169 errors before being mounted.
9170
9171 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
9172 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
9173
9174 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
9175 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
9176 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
9177 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
9178
9179 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
9180 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
9181 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
9182
9183 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
9184 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
9185 @end table
9186 @end deftp
9187
9188 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
9189 variables.
9190
9191 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
9192 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
9193 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
9194 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
9195 these.
9196 @end defvr
9197
9198 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
9199 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
9200 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
9201 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
9202 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
9203 @command{xterm}.
9204 @end defvr
9205
9206 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
9207 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
9208 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
9209 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
9210 @end defvr
9211
9212 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
9213 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
9214 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
9215 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
9216 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
9217
9218 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
9219 read-write in its own ``name space.''
9220 @end defvr
9221
9222 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
9223 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
9224 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
9225 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
9226 @end defvr
9227
9228 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
9229 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
9230 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
9231 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
9232 @end defvr
9233
9234 @node Mapped Devices
9235 @subsection Mapped Devices
9236
9237 @cindex device mapping
9238 @cindex mapped devices
9239 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
9240 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
9241 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
9242 with additional processing over the data that flows through
9243 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
9244 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
9245 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
9246 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
9247 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
9248 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
9249 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
9250 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
9251 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
9252 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
9253 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
9254 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
9255 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
9256
9257 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
9258 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
9259
9260 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
9261 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
9262 the system boots up.
9263
9264 @table @code
9265 @item source
9266 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
9267 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
9268 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
9269
9270 @item target
9271 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
9272 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
9273 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
9274 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
9275 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
9276 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
9277
9278 @item type
9279 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
9280 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
9281 @end table
9282 @end deftp
9283
9284 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
9285 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
9286 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
9287 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
9288 @end defvr
9289
9290 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
9291 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
9292 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
9293 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
9294 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
9295 @end defvr
9296
9297 @cindex disk encryption
9298 @cindex LUKS
9299 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
9300 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
9301 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
9302 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
9303 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
9304 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
9305 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
9306
9307 @example
9308 (mapped-device
9309 (source "/dev/sda3")
9310 (target "home")
9311 (type luks-device-mapping))
9312 @end example
9313
9314 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
9315 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
9316 command like:
9317
9318 @example
9319 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
9320 @end example
9321
9322 and use it as follows:
9323
9324 @example
9325 (mapped-device
9326 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
9327 (target "home")
9328 (type luks-device-mapping))
9329 @end example
9330
9331 @cindex swap encryption
9332 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
9333 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
9334 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
9335 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
9336 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
9337
9338 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
9339 may be declared as follows:
9340
9341 @example
9342 (mapped-device
9343 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
9344 (target "/dev/md0")
9345 (type raid-device-mapping))
9346 @end example
9347
9348 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
9349 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
9350 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
9351 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
9352 automatically later.
9353
9354
9355 @node User Accounts
9356 @subsection User Accounts
9357
9358 @cindex users
9359 @cindex accounts
9360 @cindex user accounts
9361 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
9362 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
9363 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
9364
9365 @example
9366 (user-account
9367 (name "alice")
9368 (group "users")
9369 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
9370 "audio" ;sound card
9371 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
9372 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
9373 (comment "Bob's sister")
9374 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
9375 @end example
9376
9377 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
9378 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
9379 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
9380 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
9381 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
9382 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
9383 as declared.
9384
9385 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
9386 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
9387 be specified:
9388
9389 @table @asis
9390 @item @code{name}
9391 The name of the user account.
9392
9393 @item @code{group}
9394 @cindex groups
9395 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
9396 this account belongs to.
9397
9398 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
9399 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
9400 account belongs to.
9401
9402 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
9403 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
9404 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
9405 account is created.
9406
9407 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
9408 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
9409
9410 @item @code{home-directory}
9411 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
9412
9413 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
9414 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
9415 if it does not exist yet.
9416
9417 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
9418 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
9419 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
9420
9421 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
9422 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
9423 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
9424 graphical login managers do not list them.
9425
9426 @anchor{user-account-password}
9427 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
9428 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
9429 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
9430 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
9431 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
9432 reconfiguration.
9433
9434 If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
9435 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
9436 @xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
9437 on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
9438 Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
9439
9440 @end table
9441 @end deftp
9442
9443 @cindex groups
9444 User group declarations are even simpler:
9445
9446 @example
9447 (user-group (name "students"))
9448 @end example
9449
9450 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
9451 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
9452
9453 @table @asis
9454 @item @code{name}
9455 The name of the group.
9456
9457 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
9458 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
9459 automatically allocated when the group is created.
9460
9461 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
9462 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
9463 System groups have low numerical IDs.
9464
9465 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
9466 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
9467 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
9468
9469 @end table
9470 @end deftp
9471
9472 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
9473 expect:
9474
9475 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
9476 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
9477 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
9478 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
9479 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
9480 @end defvr
9481
9482 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
9483 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
9484 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
9485
9486 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
9487 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
9488 @end defvr
9489
9490 @node Locales
9491 @subsection Locales
9492
9493 @cindex locale
9494 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
9495 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
9496 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
9497 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
9498 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
9499 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
9500
9501 @cindex locale definition
9502 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
9503 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
9504 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
9505
9506 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
9507 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
9508 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
9509 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
9510 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
9511 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
9512 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
9513 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
9514
9515 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
9516 that field may be:
9517
9518 @example
9519 (cons (locale-definition
9520 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
9521 %default-locale-definitions)
9522 @end example
9523
9524 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
9525 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
9526
9527 @example
9528 (list (locale-definition
9529 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
9530 (charset "EUC-JP")))
9531 @end example
9532
9533 @vindex LOCPATH
9534 The compiled locale definitions are available at
9535 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
9536 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
9537 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
9538 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
9539 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
9540
9541 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
9542 locale)} module. Details are given below.
9543
9544 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
9545 This is the data type of a locale definition.
9546
9547 @table @asis
9548
9549 @item @code{name}
9550 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
9551 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
9552
9553 @item @code{source}
9554 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
9555 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
9556
9557 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
9558 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
9559 @uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
9560 IANA}.
9561
9562 @end table
9563 @end deftp
9564
9565 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
9566 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
9567 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
9568 declarations.
9569
9570 @cindex locale name
9571 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
9572 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
9573 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
9574 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
9575 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
9576 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
9577 @end defvr
9578
9579 @subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
9580
9581 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
9582 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
9583 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
9584 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
9585 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
9586 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
9587 another.
9588
9589 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
9590 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
9591 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
9592 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
9593 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
9594 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
9595 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
9596 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
9597 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
9598 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
9599 programs will not abort.
9600
9601 The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
9602 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
9603 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
9604 used to build the system-wide locale data.
9605
9606 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
9607 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
9608 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
9609
9610 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
9611 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
9612 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
9613 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
9614 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
9615 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
9616
9617 @example
9618 (use-package-modules base)
9619
9620 (operating-system
9621 ;; @dots{}
9622 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
9623 @end example
9624
9625 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
9626 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
9627 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
9628
9629
9630 @node Services
9631 @subsection Services
9632
9633 @cindex system services
9634 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
9635 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
9636 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
9637 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
9638 configuring network access.
9639
9640 GuixSD has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
9641 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
9642 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
9643 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
9644 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
9645 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
9646
9647 @example
9648 # herd status
9649 @end example
9650
9651 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
9652 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
9653 service:
9654
9655 @example
9656 # herd doc nscd
9657 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
9658 @end example
9659
9660 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
9661 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
9662 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
9663
9664 @example
9665 # herd stop nscd
9666 Service nscd has been stopped.
9667 # herd restart xorg-server
9668 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
9669 Service xorg-server has been started.
9670 @end example
9671
9672 The following sections document the available services, starting with
9673 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
9674 declaration.
9675
9676 @menu
9677 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
9678 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
9679 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
9680 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
9681 * X Window:: Graphical display.
9682 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
9683 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
9684 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
9685 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
9686 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
9687 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
9688 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
9689 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
9690 * Web Services:: Web servers.
9691 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
9692 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
9693 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
9694 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
9695 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
9696 * Power management Services:: The TLP tool.
9697 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
9698 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
9699 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
9700 * Game Services:: Game servers.
9701 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
9702 @end menu
9703
9704 @node Base Services
9705 @subsubsection Base Services
9706
9707 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
9708 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
9709 this module are listed below.
9710
9711 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
9712 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
9713 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
9714 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
9715 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
9716 more.
9717
9718 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
9719 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
9720 system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
9721 this:
9722
9723 @example
9724 (cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
9725 @end example
9726 @end defvr
9727
9728 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
9729 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
9730 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
9731
9732 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
9733 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
9734 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
9735
9736 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
9737 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
9738 @example
9739 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append @var{bash} "/bin/sh")))
9740 @end example
9741
9742 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
9743 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
9744 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
9745 change it to:
9746
9747 @example
9748 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append @var{bash} "/bin/sh"))
9749 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append @var{coreutils} "/bin/env")))
9750 @end example
9751
9752 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
9753 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
9754 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
9755 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
9756 (see below.)
9757 @end defvr
9758
9759 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
9760 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
9761
9762 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
9763 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
9764 symlink:
9765
9766 @example
9767 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
9768 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
9769 @end example
9770 @end deffn
9771
9772 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
9773 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
9774 @end deffn
9775
9776 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
9777 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
9778 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
9779 among other things.
9780 @end deffn
9781
9782 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
9783 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
9784
9785 @table @asis
9786
9787 @item @code{motd}
9788 @cindex message of the day
9789 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
9790
9791 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
9792 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
9793 the 'root' account has just been created.
9794
9795 @end table
9796 @end deftp
9797
9798 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
9799 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
9800 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
9801 other things.
9802 @end deffn
9803
9804 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
9805 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
9806 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
9807
9808 @table @asis
9809
9810 @item @code{tty}
9811 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
9812
9813 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
9814 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
9815 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
9816 user name and password must be entered to log in.
9817
9818 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
9819 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
9820 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
9821 the name of the log-in program.
9822
9823 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
9824 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
9825 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
9826
9827 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
9828 The Mingetty package to use.
9829
9830 @end table
9831 @end deftp
9832
9833 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
9834 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
9835 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
9836 among other things.
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
9840 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
9841 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
9842 man page for more information.
9843
9844 @table @asis
9845
9846 @item @code{tty}
9847 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
9848 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
9849 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
9850
9851 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
9852 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
9853 from it and use that.
9854
9855 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
9856 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
9857 serial port from it and use that.
9858
9859 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
9860 (baud rate etc.) alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
9861 correct values.
9862
9863 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
9864 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
9865 descending order.
9866
9867 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
9868 A string containing the value used for the @code{TERM} environment
9869 variable.
9870
9871 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
9872 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
9873 disabled.
9874
9875 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
9876 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
9877 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
9878
9879 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
9880 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
9881
9882 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
9883 This accepts a string containing the "login_host", which will be written
9884 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
9885
9886 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
9887 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
9888 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
9889 specified in @var{login-program}.
9890
9891 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
9892 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
9893
9894 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
9895 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
9896 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
9897
9898 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
9899 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
9900 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
9901
9902 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
9903 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
9904 the login prompt.
9905
9906 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
9907 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
9908 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
9909 Shadow tool suite.
9910
9911 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
9912 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
9913 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
9914 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
9915
9916 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
9917 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
9918 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
9919
9920 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
9921 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
9922 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
9923 systems.
9924
9925 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
9926 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
9927 @file{/etc/issue} file.
9928
9929 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
9930 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
9931 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
9932 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
9933 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
9934 options that could be parsed by the login program.
9935
9936 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
9937 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
9938 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
9939 lazily spawning shells.
9940
9941 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
9942 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
9943 path as a string.
9944
9945 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
9946 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
9947 specified terminal.
9948
9949 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
9950 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
9951 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
9952 character.
9953
9954 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
9955 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
9956 within @var{timeout} seconds.
9957
9958 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
9959 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
9960 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
9961 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
9962 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
9963 Unicode characters.
9964
9965 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
9966 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
9967 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
9968 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
9969 @var{init-string} option.
9970
9971 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
9972 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
9973 locks.
9974
9975 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
9976 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
9977 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
9978
9979 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
9980 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
9981 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
9982 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
9983
9984 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
9985 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
9986 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
9987
9988 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
9989 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean "ignore
9990 all previous characters" (also called a "kill" character) when the types
9991 their login name.
9992
9993 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
9994 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
9995 to before login.
9996
9997 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
9998 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
9999 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
10000
10001 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
10002 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
10003 @command{login} program.
10004
10005 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
10006 This option provides an "escape hatch" for the user to provide arbitrary
10007 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
10008
10009 @end table
10010 @end deftp
10011
10012 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
10013 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
10014 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
10015 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
10016 @end deffn
10017
10018 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
10019 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
10020 implements virtual console log-in.
10021
10022 @table @asis
10023
10024 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
10025 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
10026
10027 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
10028 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
10029 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
10030
10031 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
10032 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
10033
10034 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
10035 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
10036
10037 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
10038 The Kmscon package to use.
10039
10040 @end table
10041 @end deftp
10042
10043 @cindex name service cache daemon
10044 @cindex nscd
10045 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
10046 [#:name-services '()]
10047 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
10048 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
10049 Service Switch}, for an example.
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
10053 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
10054 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
10055 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
10056 @end defvr
10057
10058 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
10059 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
10060 configuration.
10061
10062 @table @asis
10063
10064 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
10065 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
10066 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
10067
10068 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
10069 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
10070 command.
10071
10072 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
10073 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
10074 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
10075
10076 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
10077 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
10078 debugging output is logged.
10079
10080 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
10081 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
10082 below.
10083
10084 @end table
10085 @end deftp
10086
10087 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
10088 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
10089
10090 @table @asis
10091
10092 @item @code{database}
10093 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
10094 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
10095 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
10096 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
10097
10098 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
10099 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
10100 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
10101 negative lookup result remains in cache.
10102
10103 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
10104 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
10105 @var{database}.
10106
10107 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
10108 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
10109 them into account.
10110
10111 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
10112 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
10113
10114 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
10115 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
10116
10117 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
10118 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
10119
10120 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
10121 @c settings, so leave them out.
10122
10123 @end table
10124 @end deftp
10125
10126 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
10127 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
10128 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
10129
10130 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
10131 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
10132 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
10133 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
10134 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
10135 @end defvr
10136
10137 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
10138 @cindex syslog
10139 @cindex logging
10140 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
10141 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
10142
10143 @table @asis
10144 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
10145 The syslog daemon to use.
10146
10147 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
10148 The syslog configuration file to use.
10149
10150 @end table
10151 @end deftp
10152
10153 @anchor{syslog-service}
10154 @cindex syslog
10155 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
10156 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
10157
10158 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
10159 information on the configuration file syntax.
10160 @end deffn
10161
10162 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
10163 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
10164 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
10165 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
10166
10167 @table @asis
10168 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
10169 The Guix package to use.
10170
10171 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
10172 Name of the group for build user accounts.
10173
10174 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
10175 Number of build user accounts to create.
10176
10177 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
10178 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
10179 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
10180 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{hydra.gnu.org}
10181 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10182
10183 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
10184 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @var{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
10185 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
10186 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
10187 contains that of @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10188
10189 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
10190 Whether to use substitutes.
10191
10192 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
10193 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
10194
10195 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
10196 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
10197 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
10198 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
10199 disables the timeout.
10200
10201 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
10202 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
10203 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
10204
10205 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
10206 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
10207
10208 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
10209 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
10210 are written.
10211
10212 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
10213 The HTTP proxy used for downloading fixed-output derivations and
10214 substitutes.
10215
10216 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
10217 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
10218
10219 @end table
10220 @end deftp
10221
10222 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
10223 Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
10224 @var{config}.
10225 @end deffn
10226
10227 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
10228 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
10229 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
10230 variable. The procedures @var{udev-rule} and @var{file->udev-rule} from
10231 @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the creation of such rule files.
10232
10233 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
10234 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
10235 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
10236
10237 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
10238 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
10239 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
10240
10241 @example
10242 (define %example-udev-rule
10243 (udev-rule
10244 "90-usb-thing.rules"
10245 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
10246 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
10247 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
10248 @end example
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 Here we show how the default @var{udev-service} can be extended with it.
10252
10253 @example
10254 (operating-system
10255 ;; @dots{}
10256 (services
10257 (modify-services %desktop-services
10258 (udev-service-type config =>
10259 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
10260 (rules (append (udev-configuration-rules config)
10261 (list %example-udev-rule))))))))
10262 @end example
10263
10264 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
10265 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
10266 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
10267
10268 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
10269
10270 @example
10271 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
10272 (guix packages) ;for origin
10273 ;; @dots{})
10274
10275 (define %android-udev-rules
10276 (file->udev-rule
10277 "51-android-udev.rules"
10278 (let ((version "20170910"))
10279 (origin
10280 (method url-fetch)
10281 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
10282 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
10283 (sha256
10284 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
10285 @end example
10286 @end deffn
10287
10288 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
10289 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
10290 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
10291 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
10292 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
10293 packages android)} module.
10294
10295 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
10296 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
10297 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
10298 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
10299 the rules defined within the @var{android-udev-rules} package. To
10300 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
10301 @var{supplementary-groups} of our @var{user-account} declaration, as
10302 well as in the @var{groups} field of the @var{operating-system} record.
10303
10304 @example
10305 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
10306 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
10307 ;; @dots{})
10308
10309 (operating-system
10310 ;; @dots{}
10311 (users (cons (user-acount
10312 ;; @dots{}
10313 (supplementary-groups
10314 '("adbusers" ;for adb
10315 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video"))
10316 ;; @dots{})))
10317
10318 (groups (cons (user-group (system? #t) (name "adbusers"))
10319 %base-groups))
10320
10321 ;; @dots{}
10322
10323 (services
10324 (modify-services %desktop-services
10325 (udev-service-type config =>
10326 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
10327 (rules (cons* android-udev-rules
10328 (udev-configuration-rules config))))))))
10329 @end example
10330 @end deffn
10331
10332 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
10333 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
10334 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
10335 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
10336 readable.
10337 @end defvr
10338
10339 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
10340 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
10341 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
10342 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
10343 @end defvr
10344
10345 @cindex keymap
10346 @cindex keyboard
10347 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{files} ...
10348 @cindex keyboard layout
10349 Return a service to load console keymaps from @var{files} using
10350 @command{loadkeys} command. Most likely, you want to load some default
10351 keymap, which can be done like this:
10352
10353 @example
10354 (console-keymap-service "dvorak")
10355 @end example
10356
10357 Or, for example, for a Swedish keyboard, you may need to combine
10358 the following keymaps:
10359 @example
10360 (console-keymap-service "se-lat6" "se-fi-lat6")
10361 @end example
10362
10363 Also you can specify a full file name (or file names) of your keymap(s).
10364 See @code{man loadkeys} for details.
10365
10366 @end deffn
10367
10368 @cindex mouse
10369 @cindex gpm
10370 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
10371 [#:options]
10372 Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
10373 command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
10374 notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
10375 uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
10376
10377 This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
10378 @end deffn
10379
10380 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
10381 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
10382 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
10383 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-configuration}
10384 object, as described below.
10385
10386 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
10387 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
10388 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
10389 @end deffn
10390
10391 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
10392 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
10393 service.
10394
10395 @table @asis
10396 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
10397 The Guix package to use.
10398
10399 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
10400 The TCP port to listen for connections.
10401
10402 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
10403 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
10404 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
10405
10406 @item @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
10407 The gzip compression level at which substitutes are compressed. Use
10408 @code{0} to disable compression altogether, and @code{9} to get the best
10409 compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU usage.
10410
10411 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
10412 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
10413 publish, @code{--nar-path}}, for details.
10414
10415 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
10416 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
10417 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
10418 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
10419 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
10420 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
10421
10422 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
10423 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
10424 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
10425 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
10426
10427 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
10428 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
10429 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
10430 for more information.
10431 @end table
10432 @end deftp
10433
10434 @anchor{rngd-service}
10435 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
10436 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
10437 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
10438 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
10439 @var{device} does not exist.
10440 @end deffn
10441
10442 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
10443 @cindex session limits
10444 @cindex ulimit
10445 @cindex priority
10446 @cindex realtime
10447 @cindex jackd
10448 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
10449
10450 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
10451 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
10452 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
10453 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
10454 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
10455
10456 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
10457 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
10458
10459 @example
10460 (pam-limits-service
10461 (list
10462 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
10463 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
10464 @end example
10465
10466 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
10467 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
10468 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
10469 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
10470 @end deffn
10471
10472 @node Scheduled Job Execution
10473 @subsubsection Scheduled Job Execution
10474
10475 @cindex cron
10476 @cindex mcron
10477 @cindex scheduling jobs
10478 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
10479 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
10480 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
10481 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
10482 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
10483 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
10484
10485 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
10486 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
10487 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
10488 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
10489 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
10490 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
10491 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10492
10493 @lisp
10494 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
10495 (use-package-modules base idutils)
10496
10497 (define updatedb-job
10498 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
10499 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
10500 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
10501 (lambda ()
10502 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
10503 "updatedb"
10504 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
10505
10506 (define garbage-collector-job
10507 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
10508 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
10509 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
10510 "guix gc -F 1G"))
10511
10512 (define idutils-job
10513 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
10514 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
10515 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
10516 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
10517 #:user "charlie"))
10518
10519 (operating-system
10520 ;; @dots{}
10521 (services (cons (mcron-service (list garbage-collector-job
10522 updatedb-job
10523 idutils-job))
10524 %base-services)))
10525 @end lisp
10526
10527 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
10528 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
10529 reference of the mcron service.
10530
10531 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mcron-service @var{jobs} [#:mcron @var{mcron}]
10532 Return an mcron service running @var{mcron} that schedules @var{jobs}, a
10533 list of gexps denoting mcron job specifications.
10534
10535 This is a shorthand for:
10536 @example
10537 (service mcron-service-type
10538 (mcron-configuration (mcron mcron) (jobs jobs)))
10539 @end example
10540 @end deffn
10541
10542 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
10543 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
10544 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
10545
10546 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
10547 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
10548 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
10549 mcron jobs to run.
10550 @end defvr
10551
10552 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
10553 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
10554
10555 @table @asis
10556 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
10557 The mcron package to use.
10558
10559 @item @code{jobs}
10560 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
10561 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
10562 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
10563 @end table
10564 @end deftp
10565
10566
10567 @node Log Rotation
10568 @subsubsection Log Rotation
10569
10570 @cindex rottlog
10571 @cindex log rotation
10572 @cindex logging
10573 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
10574 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
10575 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
10576 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
10577 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
10578
10579 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
10580 with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
10581
10582 @lisp
10583 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
10584 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
10585 (use-package-modules base idutils)
10586
10587 (operating-system
10588 ;; @dots{}
10589 (services (cons (service rottlog-service-type)
10590 %base-services)))
10591 @end lisp
10592
10593 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
10594 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
10595 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
10596
10597 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
10598 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
10599
10600 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
10601 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
10602 @end defvr
10603
10604 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
10605 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
10606
10607 @table @asis
10608 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
10609 The Rottlog package to use.
10610
10611 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
10612 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
10613 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
10614
10615 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
10616 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
10617
10618 @item @code{jobs}
10619 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
10620 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
10621 @end table
10622 @end deftp
10623
10624 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
10625 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
10626
10627 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
10628 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
10629 defined like this:
10630
10631 @example
10632 (log-rotation
10633 (frequency 'daily)
10634 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
10635 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
10636 "rotate 6"
10637 "notifempty"
10638 "nocompress")))
10639 @end example
10640
10641 The list of fields is as follows:
10642
10643 @table @asis
10644 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
10645 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
10646
10647 @item @code{files}
10648 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
10649
10650 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
10651 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
10652 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
10653
10654 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
10655 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
10656 @end table
10657 @end deftp
10658
10659 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
10660 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and
10661 a couple of other files.
10662 @end defvr
10663
10664 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
10665 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
10666 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure")}.
10667 @end defvr
10668
10669 @node Networking Services
10670 @subsubsection Networking Services
10671
10672 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
10673 the network interface.
10674
10675 @cindex DHCP, networking service
10676 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
10677 Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
10678 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
10679 @end deffn
10680
10681 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
10682 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
10683 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
10684 @end defvr
10685
10686 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
10687 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}]
10688 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
10689 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
10690 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
10691 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
10692 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
10693 interface.
10694
10695 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
10696 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
10697 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
10698 to handle.
10699 @end deffn
10700
10701 @cindex wicd
10702 @cindex wireless
10703 @cindex WiFi
10704 @cindex network management
10705 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
10706 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
10707 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
10708
10709 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
10710 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
10711 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
10712 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
10713 @end deffn
10714
10715 @cindex NetworkManager
10716
10717 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
10718 This is the service type for the
10719 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
10720 service. The value for this service type is a
10721 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
10722
10723 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
10724 Services}).
10725 @end defvr
10726
10727 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
10728 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
10729
10730 @table @asis
10731 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
10732 The NetworkManager package to use.
10733
10734 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
10735 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
10736 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
10737
10738 @table @samp
10739 @item default
10740 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
10741 provided by currently active connections.
10742
10743 @item dnsmasq
10744 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver,
10745 using a "split DNS" configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
10746 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
10747
10748 @item none
10749 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
10750 @end table
10751
10752 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
10753 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
10754 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
10755 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
10756
10757 @end table
10758 @end deftp
10759
10760 @cindex Connman
10761 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
10762 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
10763 a network connection manager.
10764
10765 Its value must be an
10766 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
10767
10768 @example
10769 (service connman-service-type
10770 (connman-configuration
10771 (disable-vpn? #t)))
10772 @end example
10773
10774 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
10775 @end deffn
10776
10777 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
10778 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
10779
10780 @table @asis
10781 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
10782 The connman package to use.
10783
10784 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
10785 When true, enable connman's vpn plugin.
10786 @end table
10787 @end deftp
10788
10789 @cindex WPA Supplicant
10790 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
10791 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
10792 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
10793 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks. It is configured to listen for
10794 requests on D-Bus.
10795
10796 The value of this service is the @code{wpa-supplicant} package to use.
10797 Thus, it can be instantiated like this:
10798
10799 @lisp
10800 (use-modules (gnu services networking))
10801
10802 (service wpa-supplicant-service-type)
10803 @end lisp
10804 @end defvr
10805
10806 @cindex NTP
10807 @cindex real time clock
10808 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
10809 [#:servers @var{%ntp-servers}] @
10810 [#:allow-large-adjustment? #f]
10811 Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
10812 @uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
10813 keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
10814 @var{allow-large-adjustment?} determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to
10815 make an initial adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
10816 @end deffn
10817
10818 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
10819 List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
10820 @end defvr
10821
10822 @cindex OpenNTPD
10823 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
10824 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
10825 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
10826 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
10827
10828 @example
10829 (service
10830 openntpd-service-type
10831 (openntpd-configuration
10832 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
10833 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
10834 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
10835 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
10836 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
10837
10838 @end example
10839 @end deffn
10840
10841 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
10842 @table @asis
10843 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
10844 The openntpd executable to use.
10845 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
10846 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
10847 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
10848 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
10849 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
10850 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
10851 will listen to each sensor that acutally exists and ignore non-existant ones.
10852 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
10853 information.
10854 @item @code{server} (default: @var{%ntp-servers})
10855 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
10856 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
10857 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
10858 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
10859 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
10860 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
10861 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
10862 man-in-the-middle attacks.
10863 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
10864 a constraint.
10865 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
10866 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
10867 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
10868 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
10869 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
10870 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
10871 than 180 seconds.
10872 @end table
10873 @end deftp
10874
10875 @cindex inetd
10876 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
10877 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
10878 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
10879 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
10880 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
10881
10882 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
10883 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
10884 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
10885 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
10886 gateway @code{hostname}:
10887
10888 @example
10889 (service
10890 inetd-service-type
10891 (inetd-configuration
10892 (entries (list
10893 (inetd-entry
10894 (name "echo")
10895 (socket-type 'stream)
10896 (protocol "tcp")
10897 (wait? #f)
10898 (user "root"))
10899 (inetd-entry
10900 (node "127.0.0.1")
10901 (name "smtp")
10902 (socket-type 'stream)
10903 (protocol "tcp")
10904 (wait? #f)
10905 (user "root")
10906 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
10907 (arguments
10908 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
10909 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))
10910 @end example
10911
10912 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
10913 @end deffn
10914
10915 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
10916 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
10917
10918 @table @asis
10919 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
10920 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
10921
10922 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
10923 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
10924 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
10925 @end table
10926 @end deftp
10927
10928 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
10929 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
10930 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
10931 requests.
10932
10933 @table @asis
10934 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
10935 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
10936 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
10937 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
10938 description of all options.
10939 @item @code{name}
10940 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
10941 @item @code{socket-type}
10942 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
10943 @code{'seqpacket}.
10944 @item @code{protocol}
10945 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
10946 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
10947 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
10948 listening to new service requests.
10949 @item @code{user}
10950 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
10951 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
10952 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e. @code{"user"},
10953 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
10954 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
10955 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
10956 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
10957 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
10958 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
10959 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e. the name of the
10960 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
10961 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
10962 @end table
10963
10964 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
10965 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
10966 @end deftp
10967
10968 @cindex Tor
10969 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
10970 Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
10971 networking daemon.
10972
10973 The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
10974 @var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
10975 and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
10976 @command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
10977 @end deffn
10978
10979 @cindex hidden service
10980 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
10981 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
10982 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
10983
10984 @example
10985 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
10986 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
10987 @end example
10988
10989 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
10990 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
10991
10992 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
10993 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
10994 service.
10995
10996 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
10997 project's documentation} for more information.
10998 @end deffn
10999
11000 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
11001
11002 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
11003 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
11004 files.
11005
11006 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
11007 This is the type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} rsync daemon,
11008 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
11009
11010 @example
11011 (service rsync-service-type)
11012 @end example
11013
11014 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
11015 @end deffn
11016
11017 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
11018 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
11019
11020 @table @asis
11021 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
11022 @code{rsync} package to use.
11023
11024 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
11025 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
11026 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
11027 @code{root} user and group.
11028
11029 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
11030 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
11031
11032 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
11033 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
11034
11035 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
11036 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
11037
11038 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
11039 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
11040
11041 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
11042 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
11043
11044 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
11045 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
11046
11047 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
11048 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
11049
11050 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
11051 I/O timeout in seconds.
11052
11053 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
11054 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
11055
11056 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
11057 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
11058
11059 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
11060 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
11061 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
11062
11063 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
11064 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
11065
11066 @end table
11067 @end deftp
11068
11069 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
11070 @cindex SSH
11071 @cindex SSH server
11072
11073 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
11074 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
11075 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
11076 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
11077 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
11078 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
11079 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
11080 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
11081 only by root.
11082
11083 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
11084 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
11085 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
11086 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
11087 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
11088
11089 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
11090 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
11091 require interaction.
11092
11093 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
11094 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
11095 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
11096 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
11097
11098 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
11099 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
11100 or addresses.
11101
11102 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
11103 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
11104 root.
11105
11106 The other options should be self-descriptive.
11107 @end deffn
11108
11109 @cindex SSH
11110 @cindex SSH server
11111 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
11112 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
11113 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
11114 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
11115
11116 @example
11117 (service openssh-service-type
11118 (openssh-configuration
11119 (x11-forwarding? #t)
11120 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
11121 (authorized-keys
11122 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
11123 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
11124 @end example
11125
11126 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
11127
11128 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
11129 example:
11130
11131 @example
11132 (service-extension openssh-service-type
11133 (const `(("charlie"
11134 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
11135 @end example
11136 @end deffn
11137
11138 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
11139 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
11140
11141 @table @asis
11142 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
11143 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
11144
11145 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
11146 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
11147
11148 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
11149 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
11150 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
11151 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
11152 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
11153
11154 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
11155 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
11156 not.
11157
11158 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
11159 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
11160 other authentication methods.
11161
11162 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
11163 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
11164 false, users have to use other authentication method.
11165
11166 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
11167 This is used only by protocol version 2.
11168
11169 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
11170 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
11171 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
11172 @option{-Y} will work.
11173
11174 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
11175 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g. via
11176 PAM).
11177
11178 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
11179 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
11180 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
11181 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
11182 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
11183 module processing for all authentication types.
11184
11185 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
11186 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
11187 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
11188 @code{password-authentication?}.
11189
11190 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
11191 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
11192 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
11193
11194 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
11195 Configures external subsystems (e.g. file transfer daemon).
11196
11197 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
11198 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
11199 subsystem request.
11200
11201 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
11202 server. Alternately, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
11203 @example
11204 (service openssh-service-type
11205 (openssh-configuration
11206 (subsystems
11207 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
11208 @end example
11209
11210 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
11211 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
11212
11213 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
11214 @code{man sshd_config}.
11215
11216 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @code{COLORTERM} variable.
11217 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
11218 your shell's ressource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
11219 if this variable is set.
11220
11221 @example
11222 (service openssh-service-type
11223 (openssh-configuration
11224 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
11225 @end example
11226
11227 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
11228 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
11229 @cindex SSH authorized keys
11230 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
11231 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
11232 keys. For example:
11233
11234 @example
11235 (openssh-configuration
11236 (authorized-keys
11237 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
11238 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
11239 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
11240 @end example
11241
11242 @noindent
11243 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
11244 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
11245
11246 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
11247 @code{service-extension}.
11248
11249 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
11250 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
11251 @end table
11252 @end deftp
11253
11254 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
11255 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
11256 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
11257 object.
11258
11259 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
11260 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
11261
11262 @example
11263 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
11264 (port-number 1234)))
11265 @end example
11266 @end deffn
11267
11268 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
11269 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
11270
11271 @table @asis
11272 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
11273 The Dropbear package to use.
11274
11275 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
11276 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
11277
11278 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
11279 Whether to enable syslog output.
11280
11281 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
11282 File name of the daemon's PID file.
11283
11284 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
11285 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
11286
11287 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
11288 Whether to allow empty passwords.
11289
11290 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
11291 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
11292 @end table
11293 @end deftp
11294
11295 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
11296 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
11297 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
11298 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
11299 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
11300 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
11301
11302 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
11303 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
11304 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
11305
11306 @example
11307 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
11308
11309 (operating-system
11310 (host-name "mymachine")
11311 ;; ...
11312 (hosts-file
11313 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
11314 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
11315 (plain-file "hosts"
11316 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
11317 %facebook-host-aliases))))
11318 @end example
11319
11320 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
11321 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
11322 @end defvr
11323
11324 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
11325
11326 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
11327 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
11328 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
11329 [#:domains-to-browse '()] [#:debug? #f]
11330 Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
11331 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
11332 "zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
11333 extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
11334 @code{.local} host names using
11335 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
11336 add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
11337 @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
11338
11339 If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
11340 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
11341
11342 When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
11343 in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
11344 address via mDNS on the local network.
11345
11346 When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
11347
11348 Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
11349 sockets.
11350 @end deffn
11351
11352 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
11353 This is the type of the @uref{http://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
11354 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
11355 object.
11356 @end deffn
11357
11358 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
11359 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
11360 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
11361 through programmatic extension.
11362
11363 @table @asis
11364 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
11365 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
11366
11367 @end table
11368 @end deftp
11369
11370 @node X Window
11371 @subsubsection X Window
11372
11373 @cindex X11
11374 @cindex X Window System
11375 @cindex login manager
11376 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
11377 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
11378 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
11379 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default SLiM.
11380
11381 @cindex window manager
11382 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
11383 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
11384 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
11385 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
11386
11387 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
11388 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
11389
11390 @cindex session types (X11)
11391 @cindex X11 session types
11392 SLiM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
11393 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to
11394 choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such
11395 as @code{xfce}, @code{sawfish}, and @code{ratpoison} provide
11396 @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide set of packages
11397 automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
11398
11399 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
11400 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
11401 and/or other X clients.
11402 @end defvr
11403
11404 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
11405 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
11406
11407 @table @asis
11408 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
11409 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
11410
11411 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
11412 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
11413 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
11414
11415 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
11416 @code{default-user}.
11417
11418 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
11419 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
11420 The graphical theme to use and its name.
11421
11422 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
11423 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
11424 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
11425
11426 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
11427 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
11428 will be used.
11429
11430 @quotation Note
11431 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
11432 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
11433 false, you will be unable to log in.
11434 @end quotation
11435
11436 @item @code{startx} (default: @code{(xorg-start-command)})
11437 The command used to start the X11 graphical server.
11438
11439 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
11440 The XAuth package to use.
11441
11442 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
11443 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
11444 @command{reboot}.
11445
11446 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
11447 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
11448
11449 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
11450 The SLiM package to use.
11451 @end table
11452 @end deftp
11453
11454 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
11455 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
11456 The default SLiM theme and its name.
11457 @end defvr
11458
11459
11460 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
11461 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
11462
11463 @table @asis
11464 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
11465 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
11466 or "wayland".
11467
11468 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
11469 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
11470
11471 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
11472 Command to run when halting.
11473
11474 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
11475 Command to run when rebooting.
11476
11477 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
11478 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
11479
11480 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
11481 Directory to look for themes.
11482
11483 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
11484 Directory to look for faces.
11485
11486 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
11487 Default PATH to use.
11488
11489 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default 1000)
11490 Minimum UID to display in SDDM.
11491
11492 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default 2000)
11493 Maximum UID to display in SDDM
11494
11495 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
11496 Remember last user.
11497
11498 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
11499 Remember last session.
11500
11501 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
11502 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
11503
11504 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
11505 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
11506
11507 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
11508 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
11509
11510 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
11511 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
11512
11513 @item @code{xorg-server-path} (default @code{xorg-start-command})
11514 Path to xorg-server.
11515
11516 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
11517 Path to xauth.
11518
11519 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
11520 Path to Xephyr.
11521
11522 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
11523 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
11524
11525 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
11526 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
11527
11528 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitr })
11529 Script to run before starting a X session.
11530
11531 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
11532 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
11533
11534 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
11535 Minimum VT to use.
11536
11537 @item @code{xserver-arguments} (default "-nolisten tcp")
11538 Arguments to pass to xorg-server.
11539
11540 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
11541 User to use for auto-login.
11542
11543 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
11544 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
11545
11546 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
11547 Relogin after logout.
11548
11549 @end table
11550 @end deftp
11551
11552 @cindex login manager
11553 @cindex X11 login
11554 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sddm-service config
11555 Return a service that spawns the SDDM graphical login manager for config of
11556 type @code{<sddm-configuration>}.
11557
11558 @example
11559 (sddm-service (sddm-configuration
11560 (auto-login-user "Alice")
11561 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
11562 @end example
11563 @end deffn
11564
11565 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
11566 [#:modules %default-xorg-modules] @
11567 [#:fonts %default-xorg-fonts] @
11568 [#:configuration-file (xorg-configuration-file @dots{})] @
11569 [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
11570 Return a @code{startx} script in which @var{modules}, a list of X module
11571 packages, and @var{fonts}, a list of X font directories, are available. See
11572 @code{xorg-wrapper} for more details on the arguments. The result should be
11573 used in place of @code{startx}.
11574
11575 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
11576 @end deffn
11577
11578 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
11579 [#:modules %default-xorg-modules] @
11580 [#:fonts %default-xorg-fonts] @
11581 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
11582 Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
11583 all the common drivers.
11584
11585 @var{modules} must be a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
11586 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
11587 @var{fonts} must be a list of font directories to add to the server's
11588 @dfn{font path}.
11589
11590 @var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
11591 graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
11592 this order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
11593
11594 Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
11595 appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
11596 resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
11597
11598 Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
11599 configuration file. It is used to pass extra text to be
11600 added verbatim to the configuration file.
11601 @end deffn
11602
11603 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
11604 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
11605 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
11606 for it. For example:
11607
11608 @lisp
11609 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
11610 @end lisp
11611
11612 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
11613 @end deffn
11614
11615
11616 @node Printing Services
11617 @subsubsection Printing Services
11618
11619 @cindex printer support with CUPS
11620 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
11621 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a GuixSD
11622 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
11623
11624 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
11625 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
11626 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
11627 write:
11628 @example
11629 (service cups-service-type)
11630 @end example
11631 @end deffn
11632
11633 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
11634 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
11635 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
11636 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
11637 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
11638 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
11639 secure connections to the print server.
11640
11641 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
11642 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
11643 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip} package. You can do that directly,
11644 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
11645
11646 @example
11647 (service cups-service-type
11648 (cups-configuration
11649 (web-interface? #t)
11650 (extensions
11651 (list cups-filters escpr hplip))))
11652 @end example
11653
11654 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
11655 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
11656 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
11657 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
11658 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
11659 from some other system; see the end for more details.
11660
11661 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
11662 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
11663 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
11664 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
11665 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
11666 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
11667 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
11668
11669
11670 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
11671
11672 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
11673 The CUPS package.
11674 @end deftypevr
11675
11676 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
11677 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
11678 @end deftypevr
11679
11680 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
11681 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
11682 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
11683
11684 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
11685
11686 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
11687 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
11688 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
11689 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
11690 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
11691 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
11692 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
11693 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
11694
11695 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
11696 @end deftypevr
11697
11698 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
11699 Where CUPS should cache data.
11700
11701 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
11702 @end deftypevr
11703
11704 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
11705 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
11706 writes.
11707
11708 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
11709 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
11710 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
11711 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
11712 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
11713
11714 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
11715 @end deftypevr
11716
11717 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
11718 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
11719 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
11720 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
11721 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
11722 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
11723 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
11724 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
11725
11726 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
11727 @end deftypevr
11728
11729 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
11730 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
11731 kind strings are:
11732
11733 @table @code
11734 @item none
11735 No errors are fatal.
11736
11737 @item all
11738 All of the errors below are fatal.
11739
11740 @item browse
11741 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
11742 to the DNS-SD daemon.
11743
11744 @item config
11745 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
11746
11747 @item listen
11748 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
11749 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
11750
11751 @item log
11752 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
11753
11754 @item permissions
11755 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
11756 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
11757 @end table
11758
11759 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
11760 @end deftypevr
11761
11762 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
11763 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
11764 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
11765
11766 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11767 @end deftypevr
11768
11769 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
11770 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
11771 programs.
11772
11773 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
11774 @end deftypevr
11775
11776 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
11777 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
11778
11779 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
11780 @end deftypevr
11781
11782 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
11783 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
11784 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
11785 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
11786 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
11787 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
11788 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
11789 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
11790
11791 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
11792 @end deftypevr
11793
11794 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
11795 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
11796 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
11797
11798 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
11799 @end deftypevr
11800
11801 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
11802 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
11803 data.
11804
11805 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
11806 @end deftypevr
11807
11808 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
11809 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
11810 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
11811 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
11812 used/supported on macOS.
11813
11814 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
11815 @end deftypevr
11816
11817 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
11818 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
11819 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
11820 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
11821 PEM-encoded private keys.
11822
11823 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
11824 @end deftypevr
11825
11826 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
11827 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
11828
11829 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
11830 @end deftypevr
11831
11832 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
11833 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
11834 configuration or state files.
11835
11836 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11837 @end deftypevr
11838
11839 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
11840 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
11841 @end deftypevr
11842
11843 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
11844 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
11845
11846 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
11847 @end deftypevr
11848
11849 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
11850 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
11851 programs.
11852
11853 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
11854 @end deftypevr
11855 @end deftypevr
11856
11857 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
11858 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
11859 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
11860 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
11861 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
11862 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
11863 level logs all requests.
11864
11865 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
11866 @end deftypevr
11867
11868 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
11869 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
11870 longer required for quotas.
11871
11872 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11873 @end deftypevr
11874
11875 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
11876 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
11877
11878 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
11879 @end deftypevr
11880
11881 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
11882 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
11883
11884 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11885 @end deftypevr
11886
11887 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
11888 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
11889
11890 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11891 @end deftypevr
11892
11893 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
11894 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
11895 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
11896 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
11897 secure printing functions.
11898
11899 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11900 @end deftypevr
11901
11902 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
11903 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
11904 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
11905
11906 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11907 @end deftypevr
11908
11909 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
11910 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
11911
11912 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
11913 @end deftypevr
11914
11915 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
11916 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
11917
11918 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
11919 @end deftypevr
11920
11921 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
11922 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
11923
11924 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
11925 @end deftypevr
11926
11927 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
11928 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
11929 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
11930 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
11931 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
11932
11933 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
11934 @end deftypevr
11935
11936 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
11937 Specifies the default access policy to use.
11938
11939 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
11940 @end deftypevr
11941
11942 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
11943 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
11944
11945 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11946 @end deftypevr
11947
11948 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
11949 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
11950 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
11951 typically within a few milliseconds.
11952
11953 Defaults to @samp{30}.
11954 @end deftypevr
11955
11956 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
11957 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
11958 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
11959 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
11960 @code{retry-this-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
11961 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
11962
11963 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
11964 @end deftypevr
11965
11966 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
11967 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
11968 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
11969 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
11970 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
11971 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
11972 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
11973 at any time.
11974
11975 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11976 @end deftypevr
11977
11978 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
11979 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
11980 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
11981 lowest priority.
11982
11983 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11984 @end deftypevr
11985
11986 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
11987 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
11988 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
11989 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
11990 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
11991 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
11992 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
11993
11994 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11995 @end deftypevr
11996
11997 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
11998 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
11999 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
12000
12001 Defaults to @samp{30}.
12002 @end deftypevr
12003
12004 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
12005 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
12006 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
12007 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
12008 @code{retry-current-job}.
12009
12010 Defaults to @samp{30}.
12011 @end deftypevr
12012
12013 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
12014 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
12015 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
12016 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
12017 @code{retry-current-job}.
12018
12019 Defaults to @samp{5}.
12020 @end deftypevr
12021
12022 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
12023 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
12024
12025 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
12026 @end deftypevr
12027
12028 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
12029 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
12030
12031 Defaults to @samp{30}.
12032 @end deftypevr
12033
12034 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
12035 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
12036 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
12037
12038 Defaults to @samp{0}.
12039 @end deftypevr
12040
12041 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
12042 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
12043 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
12044 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
12045 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
12046 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
12047 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
12048 @end deftypevr
12049
12050 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
12051 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
12052 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
12053 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
12054 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
12055 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
12056 ones.
12057
12058 Defaults to @samp{128}.
12059 @end deftypevr
12060
12061 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
12062 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
12063
12064 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
12065
12066 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
12067 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
12068 @end deftypevr
12069
12070 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
12071 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
12072 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
12073
12074 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12075 @end deftypevr
12076
12077 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
12078 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
12079
12080 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12081
12082 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
12083
12084 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
12085 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
12086 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
12087
12088 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
12089 @end deftypevr
12090
12091 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
12092 Methods to which this access control applies.
12093
12094 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12095 @end deftypevr
12096
12097 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
12098 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
12099 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
12100
12101 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12102 @end deftypevr
12103 @end deftypevr
12104 @end deftypevr
12105
12106 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
12107 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
12108 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
12109 of the LogLevel setting.
12110
12111 Defaults to @samp{100}.
12112 @end deftypevr
12113
12114 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
12115 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
12116 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
12117
12118 Defaults to @samp{info}.
12119 @end deftypevr
12120
12121 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
12122 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
12123 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
12124
12125 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
12126 @end deftypevr
12127
12128 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
12129 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
12130 the scheduler.
12131
12132 Defaults to @samp{100}.
12133 @end deftypevr
12134
12135 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
12136 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
12137 from a single address.
12138
12139 Defaults to @samp{100}.
12140 @end deftypevr
12141
12142 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
12143 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
12144 job.
12145
12146 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
12147 @end deftypevr
12148
12149 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
12150 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
12151 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
12152 held jobs.
12153
12154 Defaults to @samp{0}.
12155 @end deftypevr
12156
12157 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
12158 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
12159 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
12160
12161 Defaults to @samp{500}.
12162 @end deftypevr
12163
12164 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
12165 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
12166 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
12167
12168 Defaults to @samp{0}.
12169 @end deftypevr
12170
12171 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
12172 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
12173 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
12174
12175 Defaults to @samp{0}.
12176 @end deftypevr
12177
12178 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
12179 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
12180 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
12181
12182 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
12183 @end deftypevr
12184
12185 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
12186 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
12187 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
12188
12189 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
12190 @end deftypevr
12191
12192 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
12193 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
12194 multiple file print job, in seconds.
12195
12196 Defaults to @samp{300}.
12197 @end deftypevr
12198
12199 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
12200 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
12201 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
12202 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
12203 sequences are recognized:
12204
12205 @table @samp
12206 @item %%
12207 insert a single percent character
12208
12209 @item %@{name@}
12210 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
12211
12212 @item %C
12213 insert the number of copies for the current page
12214
12215 @item %P
12216 insert the current page number
12217
12218 @item %T
12219 insert the current date and time in common log format
12220
12221 @item %j
12222 insert the job ID
12223
12224 @item %p
12225 insert the printer name
12226
12227 @item %u
12228 insert the username
12229 @end table
12230
12231 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
12232 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
12233 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
12234 standard items.
12235
12236 Defaults to @samp{""}.
12237 @end deftypevr
12238
12239 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
12240 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
12241 of strings.
12242
12243 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12244 @end deftypevr
12245
12246 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
12247 Specifies named access control policies.
12248
12249 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
12250
12251 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
12252 Name of the policy.
12253 @end deftypevr
12254
12255 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
12256 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
12257 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
12258 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
12259 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
12260 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
12261 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
12262 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
12263 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
12264 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
12265
12266 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
12267 @end deftypevr
12268
12269 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
12270 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
12271 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
12272
12273 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
12274 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
12275 @end deftypevr
12276
12277 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
12278 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
12279 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
12280 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
12281 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
12282 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
12283 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
12284 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
12285 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
12286 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
12287
12288 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
12289 @end deftypevr
12290
12291 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
12292 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
12293 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
12294
12295 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
12296 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
12297 @end deftypevr
12298
12299 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
12300 Access control by IPP operation.
12301
12302 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12303 @end deftypevr
12304 @end deftypevr
12305
12306 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
12307 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
12308 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
12309 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
12310 value applies indefinitely.
12311
12312 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
12313 @end deftypevr
12314
12315 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
12316 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
12317 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
12318 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
12319 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
12320
12321 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
12322 @end deftypevr
12323
12324 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
12325 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
12326 restarting the scheduler.
12327
12328 Defaults to @samp{30}.
12329 @end deftypevr
12330
12331 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
12332 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
12333 into bitmaps for a printer.
12334
12335 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
12336 @end deftypevr
12337
12338 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
12339 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
12340
12341 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
12342 @end deftypevr
12343
12344 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
12345 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
12346 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
12347 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
12348 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
12349 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
12350 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
12351 @code{*}.
12352
12353 Defaults to @samp{*}.
12354 @end deftypevr
12355
12356 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
12357 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
12358
12359 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
12360 @end deftypevr
12361
12362 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
12363 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
12364 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
12365 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
12366 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
12367 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
12368 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
12369 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
12370
12371 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
12372 @end deftypevr
12373
12374 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string set-env
12375 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
12376
12377 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
12378 @end deftypevr
12379
12380 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
12381 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
12382 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
12383 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
12384 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
12385
12386 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12387 @end deftypevr
12388
12389 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
12390 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
12391 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. The
12392 @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher suites, which are
12393 required for some older clients that do not implement newer ones. The
12394 @code{AllowSSL3} option enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some
12395 older clients that do not support TLS v1.0.
12396
12397 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12398 @end deftypevr
12399
12400 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
12401 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
12402 the IPP specifications.
12403
12404 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
12405 @end deftypevr
12406
12407 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
12408 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
12409
12410 Defaults to @samp{300}.
12411
12412 @end deftypevr
12413
12414 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
12415 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
12416
12417 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
12418 @end deftypevr
12419
12420 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
12421 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
12422 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
12423 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
12424 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
12425 @code{cups-service-type}.
12426
12427 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
12428
12429 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
12430 The CUPS package.
12431 @end deftypevr
12432
12433 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
12434 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
12435 @end deftypevr
12436
12437 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
12438 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
12439 @end deftypevr
12440
12441 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
12442 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
12443 this:
12444
12445 @example
12446 (service cups-service-type
12447 (opaque-cups-configuration
12448 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
12449 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
12450 @end example
12451
12452
12453 @node Desktop Services
12454 @subsubsection Desktop Services
12455
12456 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
12457 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
12458 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
12459 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
12460 environments like GNOME, XFCE or MATE.
12461
12462 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
12463 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
12464 environment and networking:
12465
12466 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
12467 This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
12468 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
12469
12470 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
12471 @code{slim-service}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
12472 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}), energy and color
12473 management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the
12474 Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
12475 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system
12476 passwords, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi
12477 daemon, and has the name service switch service configured to be able to
12478 use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
12479 @end defvr
12480
12481 The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
12482 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
12483 Reference, @code{services}}).
12484
12485 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service},
12486 @code{xfce-desktop-service} and @code{mate-desktop-service}
12487 procedures can add GNOME, XFCE and/or MATE to a system.
12488 To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the
12489 backlight adjustment helpers and the power management utilities are
12490 added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
12491 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
12492 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
12493 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service} adds the GNOME
12494 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the XFCE service
12495 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
12496 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
12497 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
12498 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
12499 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
12500 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
12501 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
12502 adding a service made by @code{mate-desktop-service} adds the MATE
12503 metapackage to the system profile.
12504
12505 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
12506 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
12507 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of the
12508 @code{slim-service} for the graphical login manager. You should then
12509 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
12510 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
12511 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
12512 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
12513
12514 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gnome-desktop-service
12515 Return a service that adds the @code{gnome} package to the system
12516 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
12517 @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
12518 @end deffn
12519
12520 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xfce-desktop-service
12521 Return a service that adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile,
12522 and extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the
12523 file system as root from within a user session, after the user has
12524 authenticated with the administrator's password.
12525 @end deffn
12526
12527 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mate-desktop-service
12528 Return a service that adds the @code{mate} package to the system
12529 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
12530 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
12531 @end deffn
12532
12533 Because the GNOME, XFCE and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
12534 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include either of
12535 them by default. To add GNOME, XFCE or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
12536 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
12537 @code{operating-system}:
12538
12539 @example
12540 (use-modules (gnu))
12541 (use-service-modules desktop)
12542 (operating-system
12543 ...
12544 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
12545 (services (cons* (gnome-desktop-service)
12546 (xfce-desktop-service)
12547 %desktop-services))
12548 ...)
12549 @end example
12550
12551 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
12552 graphical login window.
12553
12554 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
12555 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
12556 are described below.
12557
12558 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
12559 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
12560 support for @var{services}.
12561
12562 @uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
12563 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
12564 and to be notified of system-wide events.
12565
12566 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
12567 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
12568 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
12569 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
12570 @end deffn
12571
12572 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
12573 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
12574 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
12575 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
12576 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
12577 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
12578
12579 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
12580 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
12581 when the power button is pressed.
12582
12583 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
12584 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
12585 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
12586 their default values are:
12587
12588 @table @code
12589 @item kill-user-processes?
12590 @code{#f}
12591 @item kill-only-users
12592 @code{()}
12593 @item kill-exclude-users
12594 @code{("root")}
12595 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
12596 @code{5}
12597 @item handle-power-key
12598 @code{poweroff}
12599 @item handle-suspend-key
12600 @code{suspend}
12601 @item handle-hibernate-key
12602 @code{hibernate}
12603 @item handle-lid-switch
12604 @code{suspend}
12605 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
12606 @code{ignore}
12607 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
12608 @code{#f}
12609 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
12610 @code{#f}
12611 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
12612 @code{#f}
12613 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
12614 @code{#t}
12615 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
12616 @code{30}
12617 @item idle-action
12618 @code{ignore}
12619 @item idle-action-seconds
12620 @code{(* 30 60)}
12621 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
12622 @code{10}
12623 @item runtime-directory-size
12624 @code{#f}
12625 @item remove-ipc?
12626 @code{#t}
12627 @item suspend-state
12628 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
12629 @item suspend-mode
12630 @code{()}
12631 @item hibernate-state
12632 @code{("disk")}
12633 @item hibernate-mode
12634 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
12635 @item hybrid-sleep-state
12636 @code{("disk")}
12637 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
12638 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
12639 @end table
12640 @end deffn
12641
12642 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
12643 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
12644 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
12645 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
12646 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
12647 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
12648 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
12649 accountsservice web site} for more information.
12650
12651 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
12652 package to expose as a service.
12653 @end deffn
12654
12655 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
12656 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
12657 Return a service that runs the
12658 @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
12659 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
12660 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
12661 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
12662 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
12663 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
12664 @end deffn
12665
12666 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
12667 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
12668 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
12669 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
12670 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
12671 [#:percentage-low 10] @
12672 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
12673 [#:percentage-action 2] @
12674 [#:time-low 1200] @
12675 [#:time-critical 300] @
12676 [#:time-action 120] @
12677 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
12678 Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
12679 @command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
12680 levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
12681 @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
12682 GNOME.
12683 @end deffn
12684
12685 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
12686 Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
12687 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
12688 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
12689 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
12690 @end deffn
12691
12692 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
12693 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
12694 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
12695 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
12696 tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
12697 site} for more information.
12698 @end deffn
12699
12700 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
12701 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
12702 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
12703 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
12704 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
12705 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
12706 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
12707 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
12708 means that all users are allowed.
12709 @end deffn
12710
12711 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
12712 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
12713 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
12714 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
12715 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
12716 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
12717 know the user's location.
12718 @end defvr
12719
12720 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
12721 [#:whitelist '()] @
12722 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
12723 [#:submit-data? #f]
12724 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
12725 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
12726 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
12727 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
12728 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
12729 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
12730 location databases. See
12731 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
12732 web site} for more information.
12733 @end deffn
12734
12735 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
12736 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
12737 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
12738 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
12739 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
12740 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
12741 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
12742
12743 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
12744 @end deffn
12745
12746 @node Database Services
12747 @subsubsection Database Services
12748
12749 @cindex database
12750 @cindex SQL
12751 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
12752
12753 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
12754 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
12755 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8'']
12756 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
12757 server.
12758
12759 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
12760 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
12761 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
12762 @end deffn
12763
12764 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
12765 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
12766 database server.
12767
12768 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
12769 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
12770 @end deffn
12771
12772 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
12773 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
12774
12775 @table @asis
12776 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
12777 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
12778 or @var{mysql}.
12779
12780 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
12781 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
12782
12783 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
12784 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
12785 @end table
12786 @end deftp
12787
12788 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
12789 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
12790 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
12791 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
12792 @end defvr
12793
12794 @example
12795 (service memcached-service-type)
12796 @end example
12797
12798 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
12799 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
12800
12801 @table @asis
12802 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
12803 The Memcached package to use.
12804
12805 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
12806 Network interfaces on which to listen.
12807
12808 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
12809 Port on which to accept connections on,
12810
12811 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
12812 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
12813 listening on a UDP socket.
12814
12815 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
12816 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
12817 @end table
12818 @end deftp
12819
12820 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
12821 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
12822 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
12823 @end defvr
12824
12825 @example
12826 (service mongodb-service-type)
12827 @end example
12828
12829 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
12830 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
12831
12832 @table @asis
12833 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
12834 The MongoDB package to use.
12835
12836 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
12837 The configuration file for MongoDB.
12838
12839 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
12840 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
12841 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
12842 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
12843 @end table
12844 @end deftp
12845
12846 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
12847 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
12848 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
12849 @end defvr
12850
12851 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
12852 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
12853
12854 @table @asis
12855 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
12856 The Redis package to use.
12857
12858 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
12859 Network interface on which to listen.
12860
12861 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
12862 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
12863 listening on a TCP socket.
12864
12865 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
12866 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
12867 @end table
12868 @end deftp
12869
12870 @node Mail Services
12871 @subsubsection Mail Services
12872
12873 @cindex mail
12874 @cindex email
12875 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
12876 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
12877 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
12878 in the subsections below.
12879
12880 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
12881
12882 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
12883 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
12884 @end deffn
12885
12886 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
12887 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
12888 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
12889 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
12890 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
12891 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
12892 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
12893 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
12894
12895 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
12896 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
12897
12898 @example
12899 (dovecot-service #:config
12900 (dovecot-configuration
12901 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
12902 @end example
12903
12904 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
12905 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
12906 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
12907 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
12908 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
12909 from some other system; see the end for more details.
12910
12911 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
12912 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
12913 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
12914 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
12915 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
12916 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
12917 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
12918
12919 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
12920
12921 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
12922 The dovecot package.
12923 @end deftypevr
12924
12925 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
12926 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
12927 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
12928 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
12929 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
12930 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
12931 @end deftypevr
12932
12933 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
12934 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
12935 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
12936
12937 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
12938
12939 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
12940 The name of the protocol.
12941 @end deftypevr
12942
12943 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
12944 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
12945 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
12946 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
12947 @end deftypevr
12948
12949 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
12950 Space separated list of plugins to load.
12951 @end deftypevr
12952
12953 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
12954 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
12955 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
12956 Defaults to @samp{10}.
12957 @end deftypevr
12958
12959 @end deftypevr
12960
12961 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
12962 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
12963 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
12964 @samp{lmtp}.
12965
12966 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
12967
12968 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
12969 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
12970 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
12971 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
12972 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
12973 @end deftypevr
12974
12975 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
12976 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
12977 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
12978 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
12979 Defaults to @samp{()}.
12980
12981 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
12982
12983 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
12984 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
12985 the section name.
12986 @end deftypevr
12987
12988 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
12989 The access mode for the socket.
12990 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
12991 @end deftypevr
12992
12993 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
12994 The user to own the socket.
12995 Defaults to @samp{""}.
12996 @end deftypevr
12997
12998 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
12999 The group to own the socket.
13000 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13001 @end deftypevr
13002
13003
13004 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
13005
13006 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
13007 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
13008 the section name.
13009 @end deftypevr
13010
13011 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
13012 The access mode for the socket.
13013 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
13014 @end deftypevr
13015
13016 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
13017 The user to own the socket.
13018 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13019 @end deftypevr
13020
13021 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
13022 The group to own the socket.
13023 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13024 @end deftypevr
13025
13026
13027 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
13028
13029 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
13030 The protocol to listen for.
13031 @end deftypevr
13032
13033 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
13034 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
13035 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13036 @end deftypevr
13037
13038 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
13039 The port on which to listen.
13040 @end deftypevr
13041
13042 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
13043 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
13044 @samp{required}.
13045 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13046 @end deftypevr
13047
13048 @end deftypevr
13049
13050 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
13051 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
13052 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
13053 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
13054 Defaults to @samp{1}.
13055 @end deftypevr
13056
13057 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
13058 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
13059 Defaults to @samp{0}.
13060 @end deftypevr
13061
13062 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
13063 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
13064 this.
13065 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
13066 @end deftypevr
13067
13068 @end deftypevr
13069
13070 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
13071 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
13072 constructor.
13073
13074 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
13075
13076 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
13077 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
13078 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13079 @end deftypevr
13080
13081 @end deftypevr
13082
13083 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
13084 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
13085 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
13086
13087 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
13088
13089 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
13090 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
13091 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
13092 @samp{static}.
13093 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
13094 @end deftypevr
13095
13096 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
13097 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
13098 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13099 @end deftypevr
13100
13101 @end deftypevr
13102
13103 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
13104 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
13105 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
13106
13107 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
13108
13109 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
13110 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
13111 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
13112 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
13113 @end deftypevr
13114
13115 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
13116 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
13117 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13118 @end deftypevr
13119
13120 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
13121 Override fields from passwd.
13122 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13123 @end deftypevr
13124
13125 @end deftypevr
13126
13127 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
13128 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
13129 constructor.
13130 @end deftypevr
13131
13132 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
13133 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
13134 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
13135
13136 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
13137
13138 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
13139 Name for this namespace.
13140 @end deftypevr
13141
13142 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
13143 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
13144 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
13145 @end deftypevr
13146
13147 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
13148 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
13149 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
13150 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
13151 format.
13152 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13153 @end deftypevr
13154
13155 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
13156 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
13157 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
13158 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13159 @end deftypevr
13160
13161 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
13162 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
13163 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
13164 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13165 @end deftypevr
13166
13167 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
13168 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
13169 namespace has it.
13170 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13171 @end deftypevr
13172
13173 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
13174 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
13175 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
13176 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
13177 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
13178 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
13179 and @samp{mail/}.
13180 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13181 @end deftypevr
13182
13183 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
13184 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
13185 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
13186 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
13187 hides the namespace prefix.
13188 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13189 @end deftypevr
13190
13191 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
13192 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
13193 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
13194 as @code{#t}).
13195 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13196 @end deftypevr
13197
13198 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
13199 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
13200 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13201
13202 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
13203
13204 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
13205 Name for this mailbox.
13206 @end deftypevr
13207
13208 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
13209 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
13210 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
13211 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
13212 @end deftypevr
13213
13214 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
13215 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
13216 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
13217 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
13218 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13219 @end deftypevr
13220
13221 @end deftypevr
13222
13223 @end deftypevr
13224
13225 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
13226 Base directory where to store runtime data.
13227 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
13228 @end deftypevr
13229
13230 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
13231 Greeting message for clients.
13232 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
13233 @end deftypevr
13234
13235 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
13236 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
13237 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
13238 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
13239 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
13240 here.
13241 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13242 @end deftypevr
13243
13244 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
13245 List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
13246 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13247 @end deftypevr
13248
13249 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
13250 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
13251 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
13252 processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
13253 accounts).
13254 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13255 @end deftypevr
13256
13257 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
13258 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
13259 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
13260 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
13261 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. due to a security fix).
13262 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13263 @end deftypevr
13264
13265 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
13266 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
13267 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
13268 Defaults to @samp{0}.
13269 @end deftypevr
13270
13271 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
13272 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
13273 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
13274 @end deftypevr
13275
13276 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
13277 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
13278 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
13279 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
13280 @end deftypevr
13281
13282 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
13283 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
13284 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
13285 matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
13286 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
13287 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
13288 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13289 @end deftypevr
13290
13291 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
13292 Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
13293 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
13294 for caching to be used.
13295 Defaults to @samp{0}.
13296 @end deftypevr
13297
13298 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
13299 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
13300 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
13301 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
13302 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
13303 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
13304 authentication.
13305 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
13306 @end deftypevr
13307
13308 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
13309 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
13310 0 disables caching them completely.
13311 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
13312 @end deftypevr
13313
13314 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
13315 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
13316 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
13317 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
13318 realm first.
13319 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13320 @end deftypevr
13321
13322 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
13323 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
13324 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
13325 logins.
13326 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13327 @end deftypevr
13328
13329 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
13330 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
13331 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
13332 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
13333 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
13334 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
13335 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
13336 @end deftypevr
13337
13338 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
13339 Username character translations before it's looked up from
13340 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
13341 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
13342 translated to @samp{@@}.
13343 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13344 @end deftypevr
13345
13346 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
13347 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
13348 use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
13349 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
13350 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
13351 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
13352 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
13353 @end deftypevr
13354
13355 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
13356 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
13357 username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
13358 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
13359 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
13360 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
13361 choice.
13362 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13363 @end deftypevr
13364
13365 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
13366 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
13367 mechanism.
13368 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
13369 @end deftypevr
13370
13371 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
13372 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
13373 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
13374 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
13375 Defaults to @samp{30}.
13376 @end deftypevr
13377
13378 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
13379 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
13380 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
13381 allow all keytab entries.
13382 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13383 @end deftypevr
13384
13385 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
13386 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
13387 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
13388 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
13389 file.
13390 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13391 @end deftypevr
13392
13393 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
13394 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
13395 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
13396 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
13397 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13398 @end deftypevr
13399
13400 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
13401 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
13402 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
13403 @end deftypevr
13404
13405 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
13406 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
13407 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
13408 @end deftypevr
13409
13410 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
13411 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
13412 fails.
13413 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13414 @end deftypevr
13415
13416 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
13417 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
13418 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
13419 CommonName.
13420 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13421 @end deftypevr
13422
13423 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
13424 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
13425 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
13426 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
13427 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
13428 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
13429 @end deftypevr
13430
13431 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
13432 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
13433 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
13434 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
13435 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13436 @end deftypevr
13437
13438 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
13439 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
13440 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
13441 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13442 @end deftypevr
13443
13444 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
13445 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
13446 has any connections.
13447 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
13448 @end deftypevr
13449
13450 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
13451 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
13452 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
13453 are shared within domain.
13454 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
13455 @end deftypevr
13456
13457 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
13458 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
13459 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
13460 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
13461 @end deftypevr
13462
13463 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
13464 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
13465 @samp{log-path}.
13466 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13467 @end deftypevr
13468
13469 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
13470 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
13471 @samp{info-log-path}.
13472 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13473 @end deftypevr
13474
13475 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
13476 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
13477 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
13478 standard facilities are supported.
13479 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
13480 @end deftypevr
13481
13482 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
13483 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
13484 failed.
13485 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13486 @end deftypevr
13487
13488 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
13489 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
13490 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
13491 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
13492 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
13493 ":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
13494 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13495 @end deftypevr
13496
13497 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
13498 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
13499 SQL queries.
13500 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13501 @end deftypevr
13502
13503 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
13504 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
13505 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
13506 @samp{auth-debug}.
13507 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13508 @end deftypevr
13509
13510 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
13511 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
13512 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
13513 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13514 @end deftypevr
13515
13516 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
13517 Show protocol level SSL errors.
13518 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13519 @end deftypevr
13520
13521 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
13522 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
13523 strftime(3) format.
13524 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
13525 @end deftypevr
13526
13527 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
13528 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
13529 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
13530 string.
13531 @end deftypevr
13532
13533 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
13534 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
13535 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
13536 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
13537 @end deftypevr
13538
13539 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
13540 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
13541 of possible variables you can use.
13542 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
13543 @end deftypevr
13544
13545 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
13546 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
13547 @table @code
13548 @item %$
13549 Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
13550 @item %m
13551 Message-ID
13552 @item %s
13553 Subject
13554 @item %f
13555 From address
13556 @item %p
13557 Physical size
13558 @item %w
13559 Virtual size.
13560 @end table
13561 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
13562 @end deftypevr
13563
13564 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
13565 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
13566 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
13567 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
13568 Dovecot the full location.
13569
13570 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
13571 file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
13572 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
13573 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
13574 @samp{mail-location} setting.
13575
13576 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
13577
13578 @table @samp
13579 @item %u
13580 username
13581 @item %n
13582 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
13583 @item %d
13584 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
13585 @item %h
13586 home director
13587 @end table
13588
13589 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
13590 @table @samp
13591 @item maildir:~/Maildir
13592 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
13593 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
13594 @end table
13595 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13596 @end deftypevr
13597
13598 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
13599 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
13600 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
13601 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
13602 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13603 @end deftypevr
13604
13605 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
13606
13607 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13608 @end deftypevr
13609
13610 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
13611 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
13612 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
13613 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
13614 /var/mail.
13615 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13616 @end deftypevr
13617
13618 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
13619 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
13620 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
13621 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
13622 symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
13623 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
13624 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
13625 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13626 @end deftypevr
13627
13628 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
13629 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
13630 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
13631 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
13632 names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
13633 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13634 @end deftypevr
13635
13636 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
13637 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
13638 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
13639 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13640 @end deftypevr
13641
13642 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
13643 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
13644 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
13645 nowadays by default.
13646 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13647 @end deftypevr
13648
13649 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
13650 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
13651 @table @code
13652 @item optimized
13653 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
13654 @item always
13655 Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
13656 @item never
13657 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
13658 @end table
13659 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
13660 @end deftypevr
13661
13662 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
13663 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
13664 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
13665 this isn't needed.
13666 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13667 @end deftypevr
13668
13669 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
13670 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
13671 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
13672 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13673 @end deftypevr
13674
13675 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
13676 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
13677 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
13678 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
13679 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
13680 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
13681 @end deftypevr
13682
13683 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
13684 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
13685 kB.
13686 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
13687 @end deftypevr
13688
13689 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
13690 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
13691 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
13692 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
13693 is set to 0.
13694 Defaults to @samp{500}.
13695 @end deftypevr
13696
13697 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
13698
13699 Defaults to @samp{0}.
13700 @end deftypevr
13701
13702 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
13703 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
13704 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
13705 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
13706 Defaults to @samp{1}.
13707 @end deftypevr
13708
13709 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
13710
13711 Defaults to @samp{0}.
13712 @end deftypevr
13713
13714 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
13715 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
13716 trying to create new keywords.
13717 Defaults to @samp{50}.
13718 @end deftypevr
13719
13720 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
13721 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
13722 processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
13723 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
13724 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
13725 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
13726 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
13727 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
13728 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
13729 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13730 @end deftypevr
13731
13732 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
13733 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
13734 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
13735 directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
13736 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
13737 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
13738 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
13739 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
13740 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13741 @end deftypevr
13742
13743 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
13744 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
13745 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
13746 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
13747 @end deftypevr
13748
13749 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
13750 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
13751 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
13752 @end deftypevr
13753
13754 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
13755 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
13756 LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
13757 Defaults to @samp{()}.
13758 @end deftypevr
13759
13760 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
13761 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
13762 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
13763 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
13764 Defaults to @samp{0}.
13765 @end deftypevr
13766
13767 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
13768 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
13769 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
13770 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
13771 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
13772 occur.
13773 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
13774 @end deftypevr
13775
13776 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
13777 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
13778 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
13779 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
13780 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
13781 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
13782 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13783 @end deftypevr
13784
13785 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
13786 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
13787 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
13788 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
13789 causes more disk I/O.
13790 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
13791 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
13792 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13793 @end deftypevr
13794
13795 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
13796 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
13797 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
13798 side effects.
13799 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13800 @end deftypevr
13801
13802 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
13803 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
13804 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
13805 the mail otherwise.
13806 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13807 @end deftypevr
13808
13809 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
13810 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
13811 available:
13812
13813 @table @code
13814 @item dotlock
13815 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
13816 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
13817 need write access to that directory.
13818 @item dotlock-try
13819 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
13820 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
13821 @item fcntl
13822 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
13823 @item flock
13824 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
13825 @item lockf
13826 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
13827 @end table
13828
13829 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
13830 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
13831 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
13832 them simultaneously.
13833 @end deftypevr
13834
13835 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
13836
13837 @end deftypevr
13838
13839 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
13840 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
13841 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
13842 @end deftypevr
13843
13844 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
13845 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
13846 override the lock file after this much time.
13847 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
13848 @end deftypevr
13849
13850 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
13851 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
13852 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
13853 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
13854 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
13855 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
13856 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
13857 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
13858 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
13859 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
13860 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13861 @end deftypevr
13862
13863 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
13864 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
13865 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
13866 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
13867 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13868 @end deftypevr
13869
13870 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
13871 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
13872 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
13873 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
13874 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
13875 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
13876 @end deftypevr
13877
13878 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
13879 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
13880 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
13881 updated.
13882 Defaults to @samp{0}.
13883 @end deftypevr
13884
13885 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
13886 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
13887 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
13888 @end deftypevr
13889
13890 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
13891 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
13892 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
13893 disabled.
13894 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
13895 @end deftypevr
13896
13897 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
13898 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
13899 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
13900 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
13901 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13902 @end deftypevr
13903
13904 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
13905 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
13906 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
13907 don't support this for now.
13908
13909 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
13910
13911 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
13912 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13913 @end deftypevr
13914
13915 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
13916 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
13917 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
13918 externally.
13919 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
13920 @end deftypevr
13921
13922 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
13923 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
13924 @table @code
13925 @item posix
13926 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
13927 @item sis posix
13928 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
13929 @item sis-queue posix
13930 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
13931 @end table
13932 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
13933 @end deftypevr
13934
13935 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
13936 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
13937 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
13938 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
13939 truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
13940 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
13941 @end deftypevr
13942
13943 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
13944
13945 Defaults to @samp{100}.
13946 @end deftypevr
13947
13948 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
13949
13950 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
13951 @end deftypevr
13952
13953 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
13954 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
13955 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
13956 before they eat up everything.
13957 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
13958 @end deftypevr
13959
13960 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
13961 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
13962 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
13963 at all.
13964 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
13965 @end deftypevr
13966
13967 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
13968 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
13969 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
13970 processes.
13971 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
13972 @end deftypevr
13973
13974 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
13975 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
13976 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
13977 @end deftypevr
13978
13979 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
13980 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
13981 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
13982 @end deftypevr
13983
13984 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
13985 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
13986 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
13987 root.
13988 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
13989 @end deftypevr
13990
13991 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
13992 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
13993 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
13994 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
13995 instead to a different.
13996 Defaults to @samp{""}.
13997 @end deftypevr
13998
13999 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
14000 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
14001 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
14002 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
14003 CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
14004 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14005 @end deftypevr
14006
14007 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
14008 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
14009 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14010 @end deftypevr
14011
14012 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
14013 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
14014 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
14015 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14016 @end deftypevr
14017
14018 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
14019 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
14020 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
14021 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
14022 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
14023 @end deftypevr
14024
14025 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
14026 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
14027 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
14028 @end deftypevr
14029
14030 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
14031 SSL ciphers to use.
14032 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
14033 @end deftypevr
14034
14035 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
14036 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
14037 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14038 @end deftypevr
14039
14040 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
14041 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
14042 %d expands to recipient domain.
14043 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
14044 @end deftypevr
14045
14046 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
14047 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
14048 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
14049 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14050 @end deftypevr
14051
14052 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
14053 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
14054 bouncing the mail.
14055 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14056 @end deftypevr
14057
14058 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
14059 Binary to use for sending mails.
14060 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
14061 @end deftypevr
14062
14063 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
14064 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
14065 sendmail.
14066 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14067 @end deftypevr
14068
14069 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
14070 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
14071 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
14072 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
14073 @end deftypevr
14074
14075 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
14076 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
14077 variables:
14078
14079 @table @code
14080 @item %n
14081 CRLF
14082 @item %r
14083 reason
14084 @item %s
14085 original subject
14086 @item %t
14087 recipient
14088 @end table
14089 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
14090 @end deftypevr
14091
14092 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
14093 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
14094 address.
14095 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
14096 @end deftypevr
14097
14098 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
14099 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
14100 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
14101 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
14102 X-Original-To.
14103 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14104 @end deftypevr
14105
14106 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
14107 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
14108 it?.
14109 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14110 @end deftypevr
14111
14112 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
14113 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
14114 subscribed?.
14115 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14116 @end deftypevr
14117
14118 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
14119 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
14120 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
14121 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
14122 often.
14123 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
14124 @end deftypevr
14125
14126 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
14127 IMAP logout format string:
14128 @table @code
14129 @item %i
14130 total number of bytes read from client
14131 @item %o
14132 total number of bytes sent to client.
14133 @end table
14134 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
14135 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
14136 @end deftypevr
14137
14138 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
14139 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
14140 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
14141 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14142 @end deftypevr
14143
14144 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
14145 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
14146 is IDLEing.
14147 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
14148 @end deftypevr
14149
14150 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
14151 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
14152 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
14153 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
14154 support-email.
14155 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14156 @end deftypevr
14157
14158 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
14159 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
14160 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14161 @end deftypevr
14162
14163 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
14164 Workarounds for various client bugs:
14165
14166 @table @code
14167 @item delay-newmail
14168 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
14169 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
14170 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
14171 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
14172 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
14173 "Headers Only".
14174
14175 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
14176 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
14177 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
14178 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
14179
14180 @item tb-lsub-flags
14181 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
14182 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
14183 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
14184 @end table
14185 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14186 @end deftypevr
14187
14188 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
14189 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
14190 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14191 @end deftypevr
14192
14193
14194 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
14195 that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
14196 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
14197 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
14198 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
14199
14200 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
14201 and running. In that case, you can pass an
14202 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
14203 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
14204 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
14205
14206 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
14207
14208 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
14209 The dovecot package.
14210 @end deftypevr
14211
14212 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
14213 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
14214 @end deftypevr
14215
14216 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
14217 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
14218
14219 @example
14220 (dovecot-service #:config
14221 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
14222 (string "")))
14223 @end example
14224
14225 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
14226
14227 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
14228 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
14229 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
14230 as in this example:
14231
14232 @example
14233 (service opensmtpd-service-type
14234 (opensmtpd-configuration
14235 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
14236 @end example
14237 @end deffn
14238
14239 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
14240 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
14241
14242 @table @asis
14243 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
14244 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
14245
14246 @item @code{config-file} (default: @var{%default-opensmtpd-file})
14247 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
14248 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
14249 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
14250 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
14251
14252 @end table
14253 @end deftp
14254
14255 @subsubheading Exim Service
14256
14257 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
14258 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
14259 @cindex SMTP
14260
14261 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
14262 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
14263 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
14264 as in this example:
14265
14266 @example
14267 (service exim-service-type
14268 (exim-configuration
14269 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
14270 @end example
14271 @end deffn
14272
14273 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
14274 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
14275 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
14276
14277 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
14278 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
14279
14280 @table @asis
14281 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
14282 Package object of the Exim server.
14283
14284 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
14285 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
14286 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
14287 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
14288 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
14289 variables.
14290
14291 @end table
14292 @end deftp
14293
14294 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
14295
14296 @cindex email aliases
14297 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
14298
14299 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
14300 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
14301 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
14302
14303 @example
14304 (service mail-aliases-service-type
14305 '(("postmaster" "bob")
14306 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
14307 @end example
14308 @end deffn
14309
14310 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
14311 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
14312 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
14313 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
14314 where to deliver this user's mail.
14315
14316 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
14317 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
14318 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
14319 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
14320 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
14321
14322 @node Messaging Services
14323 @subsubsection Messaging Services
14324
14325 @cindex messaging
14326 @cindex jabber
14327 @cindex XMPP
14328 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
14329 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
14330
14331 @subsubheading Prosody Service
14332
14333 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
14334 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
14335 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
14336 record as in this example:
14337
14338 @example
14339 (service prosody-service-type
14340 (prosody-configuration
14341 (modules-enabled (cons "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
14342 (int-components
14343 (list
14344 (int-component-configuration
14345 (hostname "conference.example.net")
14346 (plugin "muc")
14347 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
14348 (virtualhosts
14349 (list
14350 (virtualhost-configuration
14351 (domain "example.net"))))))
14352 @end example
14353
14354 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
14355
14356 @end deffn
14357
14358 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
14359 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
14360 Prosody to serve.
14361
14362 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
14363 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
14364
14365 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
14366 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
14367 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
14368
14369 @example
14370 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
14371 @end example
14372
14373 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
14374 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
14375 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
14376 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
14377 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
14378
14379 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
14380 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
14381 some other system; see the end for more details.
14382
14383 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
14384 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
14385
14386 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
14387 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
14388 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
14389 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
14390 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
14391 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
14392 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
14393
14394 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
14395
14396 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
14397 The Prosody package.
14398 @end deftypevr
14399
14400 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
14401 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
14402 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
14403 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
14404 @end deftypevr
14405
14406 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
14407 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
14408 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
14409 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14410 @end deftypevr
14411
14412 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
14413 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
14414 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
14415 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
14416 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
14417 @end deftypevr
14418
14419 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
14420 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
14421 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
14422 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
14423 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
14424 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14425 @end deftypevr
14426
14427 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
14428 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
14429 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
14430 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14431 @end deftypevr
14432
14433 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
14434 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
14435 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
14436 Documentation on modules can be found at:
14437 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
14438 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
14439 @end deftypevr
14440
14441 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
14442 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
14443 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
14444 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14445 @end deftypevr
14446
14447 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
14448 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
14449 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
14450 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
14451 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
14452 @end deftypevr
14453
14454 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
14455 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
14456 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
14457 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14458 @end deftypevr
14459
14460 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
14461 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
14462 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
14463 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
14464 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
14465
14466 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
14467
14468 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
14469 This determines what handshake to use.
14470 @end deftypevr
14471
14472 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
14473 Path to your private key file.
14474 @end deftypevr
14475
14476 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
14477 Path to your certificate file.
14478 @end deftypevr
14479
14480 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
14481 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
14482 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
14483 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
14484 @end deftypevr
14485
14486 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
14487 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
14488 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
14489 @end deftypevr
14490
14491 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
14492 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
14493 @code{set_verify()} flags).
14494 @end deftypevr
14495
14496 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
14497 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
14498 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
14499 LuaSec source.
14500 @end deftypevr
14501
14502 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
14503 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
14504 trusted root certificate.
14505 @end deftypevr
14506
14507 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
14508 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
14509 clients, and in what order.
14510 @end deftypevr
14511
14512 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
14513 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
14514 can create such a file with:
14515 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
14516 @end deftypevr
14517
14518 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
14519 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
14520 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
14521 @end deftypevr
14522
14523 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
14524 A list of "extra" verification options.
14525 @end deftypevr
14526
14527 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
14528 Password for encrypted private keys.
14529 @end deftypevr
14530
14531 @end deftypevr
14532
14533 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
14534 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
14535 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
14536 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14537 @end deftypevr
14538
14539 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
14540 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
14541 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
14542 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
14543 @end deftypevr
14544
14545 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
14546 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
14547 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
14548 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14549 @end deftypevr
14550
14551 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
14552 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
14553 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
14554 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
14555 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
14556 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14557 @end deftypevr
14558
14559 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
14560 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
14561 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
14562 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
14563 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
14564 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14565 @end deftypevr
14566
14567 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
14568 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
14569 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
14570 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
14571 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14572 @end deftypevr
14573
14574 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
14575 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
14576 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
14577 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
14578 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
14579 about using the hashed backend. See also
14580 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
14581 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
14582 @end deftypevr
14583
14584 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
14585 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
14586 by the GuixSD Prosody Service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
14587 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
14588 @end deftypevr
14589
14590 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
14591 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
14592 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
14593 @end deftypevr
14594
14595 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
14596 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
14597 @end deftypevr
14598
14599 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
14600 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
14601 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
14602 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
14603 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
14604 @end deftypevr
14605
14606 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
14607 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
14608 example if you want your users to have addresses like
14609 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
14610 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
14611
14612 Note: the name "virtual" host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
14613 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
14614 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
14615 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
14616 have just one VirtualHost entry.
14617
14618 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
14619
14620 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
14621
14622 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
14623 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
14624 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
14625 @end deftypevr
14626
14627 @end deftypevr
14628
14629 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
14630 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
14631 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
14632 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
14633 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
14634
14635 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
14636 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
14637 to use for the component.
14638
14639 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
14640 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14641
14642 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
14643
14644 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
14645 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
14646 Hostname of the component.
14647 @end deftypevr
14648
14649 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
14650 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
14651 @end deftypevr
14652
14653 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
14654 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
14655 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
14656
14657 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
14658 in the "Chatrooms" documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
14659 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
14660
14661 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
14662
14663 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
14664
14665 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
14666 The name to return in service discovery responses.
14667 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
14668 @end deftypevr
14669
14670 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
14671 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
14672 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
14673 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g. @samp{user@@example.com}
14674 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
14675 restricts to service administrators only.
14676 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14677 @end deftypevr
14678
14679 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
14680 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
14681 just joined the room.
14682 Defaults to @samp{20}.
14683 @end deftypevr
14684
14685 @end deftypevr
14686
14687 @end deftypevr
14688
14689 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
14690 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
14691 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
14692 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
14693 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14694
14695 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
14696
14697 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
14698 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
14699 Password which the component will use to log in.
14700 @end deftypevr
14701
14702 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
14703 Hostname of the component.
14704 @end deftypevr
14705
14706 @end deftypevr
14707
14708 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
14709 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
14710 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
14711 @end deftypevr
14712
14713 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
14714 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
14715 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
14716 @end deftypevr
14717
14718 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
14719 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
14720 @end deftypevr
14721
14722 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
14723 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
14724 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
14725 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
14726 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
14727 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
14728
14729 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
14730 The prosody package.
14731 @end deftypevr
14732
14733 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
14734 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
14735 @end deftypevr
14736
14737 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
14738 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
14739
14740 @example
14741 (service prosody-service-type
14742 (opaque-prosody-configuration
14743 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
14744 @end example
14745
14746 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
14747
14748 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
14749
14750 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
14751 @cindex IRC gateway
14752 @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
14753 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
14754
14755 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
14756 This is the service type for the @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
14757 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
14758 below).
14759
14760 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
14761 services:
14762
14763 @example
14764 (service bitlbee-service-type)
14765 @end example
14766 @end defvr
14767
14768 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
14769 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
14770
14771 @table @asis
14772 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
14773 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
14774 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
14775 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
14776
14777 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
14778 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
14779 networking interface.
14780
14781 @item @code{package} (default: @code{bitlbee})
14782 The BitlBee package to use.
14783
14784 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
14785 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
14786 @end table
14787 @end deftp
14788
14789
14790 @node Telephony Services
14791 @subsubsection Telephony Services
14792
14793 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
14794 @cindex VoIP server
14795 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
14796 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
14797 (VoIP) suite.
14798
14799 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
14800 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
14801 look like this:
14802
14803 @example
14804 (service murmur-service-type
14805 (murmur-configuration
14806 (welcome-text
14807 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on GuixSD!")
14808 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
14809 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
14810 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
14811 @end example
14812
14813 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
14814 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
14815
14816 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
14817 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
14818 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
14819 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
14820 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
14821 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
14822 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
14823 rights and create some channels.
14824
14825 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
14826
14827 @table @asis
14828 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
14829 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
14830
14831 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
14832 User who will run the Murmur server.
14833
14834 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
14835 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
14836
14837 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
14838 Port on which the server will listen.
14839
14840 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
14841 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
14842
14843 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
14844 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
14845
14846 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
14847 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
14848
14849 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
14850 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
14851
14852 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
14853 File name of the sqlite database.
14854 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
14855
14856 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
14857 File name of the log file.
14858 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
14859
14860 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
14861 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
14862 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
14863
14864 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
14865 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
14866
14867 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
14868 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
14869 when violating the autoban limits.
14870
14871 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
14872 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
14873 before switching over to opus audio codec.
14874
14875 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
14876 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
14877
14878 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
14879 A string in from of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
14880
14881 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
14882 A string in from of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
14883
14884 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
14885 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
14886
14887 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
14888 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
14889
14890 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
14891 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentification
14892 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
14893
14894 @item @code{remember-channel?} (defualt @code{#f})
14895 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
14896 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
14897
14898 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
14899 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
14900
14901 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
14902 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
14903 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
14904 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
14905
14906 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
14907
14908 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
14909 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
14910
14911 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
14912 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
14913
14914 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
14915 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
14916 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
14917 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
14918
14919 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default @code{#t})
14920 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
14921
14922 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
14923 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
14924
14925 @example
14926 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
14927 @end example
14928 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
14929 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
14930 @example
14931 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
14932 @end example
14933
14934 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
14935 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
14936 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
14937 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
14938 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
14939
14940 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
14941 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
14942 in SSL/TLS.
14943
14944 This option is specified using
14945 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
14946 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
14947
14948 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
14949 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
14950 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
14951 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
14952
14953 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
14954 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
14955 to connect to it.
14956
14957 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
14958 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
14959
14960 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
14961 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
14962 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
14963 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
14964
14965 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
14966
14967 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
14968 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
14969 @end table
14970 @end deftp
14971
14972 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
14973 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
14974
14975 @table @asis
14976 @item @code{name}
14977 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
14978
14979 @item @code{password}
14980 A password to identify your registration.
14981 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
14982
14983 @item @code{url}
14984 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
14985 site.
14986
14987 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
14988 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
14989 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
14990 @end table
14991 @end deftp
14992
14993
14994
14995 @node Monitoring Services
14996 @subsubsection Monitoring Services
14997
14998 @subsubheading Tailon Service
14999
15000 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
15001 viewing and searching log files.
15002
15003 The following example will configure the service with default values.
15004 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
15005
15006 @example
15007 (service tailon-service-type)
15008 @end example
15009
15010 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
15011 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
15012
15013 @example
15014 (service tailon-service-type
15015 (tailon-configuration
15016 (config-file
15017 (tailon-configuration-file
15018 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
15019 @end example
15020
15021
15022 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
15023 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
15024 This type has the following parameters:
15025
15026 @table @asis
15027 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
15028 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
15029 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
15030 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
15031
15032 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
15033 can be used:
15034
15035 @example
15036 (service tailon-service-type
15037 (tailon-configuration
15038 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
15039 @end example
15040
15041 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
15042 The tailon package to use.
15043
15044 @end table
15045 @end deftp
15046
15047 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
15048 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
15049 This type has the following parameters:
15050
15051 @table @asis
15052 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
15053 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
15054 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
15055 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
15056 subsection.
15057
15058 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
15059 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
15060
15061 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
15062 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
15063
15064 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
15065 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
15066
15067 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
15068 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
15069
15070 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
15071 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
15072
15073 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
15074 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
15075
15076 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
15077 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
15078
15079 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
15080 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
15081 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
15082 wrap lines.
15083
15084 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
15085 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
15086 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
15087 @code{"basic"}.
15088
15089 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
15090 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
15091 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
15092 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
15093 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
15094
15095 @example
15096 (tailon-configuration-file
15097 (http-auth "basic")
15098 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
15099 ("user2" . "password2"))))
15100 @end example
15101
15102 @end table
15103 @end deftp
15104
15105
15106 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
15107 @cindex darkstat
15108 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
15109 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
15110
15111 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
15112 This is the service type for the
15113 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
15114 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
15115 this example:
15116
15117 @example
15118 (service darkstat-service-type
15119 (darkstat-configuration
15120 (interface "eno1")))
15121 @end example
15122 @end defvar
15123
15124 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
15125 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
15126
15127 @table @asis
15128 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
15129 The darkstat package to use.
15130
15131 @item @code{interface}
15132 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
15133
15134 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
15135 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
15136
15137 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
15138 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
15139
15140 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
15141 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
15142 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
15143
15144 @end table
15145 @end deftp
15146
15147
15148 @node Kerberos Services
15149 @subsubsection Kerberos Services
15150 @cindex Kerberos
15151
15152 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
15153 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
15154
15155 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
15156
15157 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
15158 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
15159 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
15160 operating system declaration.
15161 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
15162
15163 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
15164 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
15165 Other implementations have not been tested.
15166
15167 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
15168 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
15169 @end defvr
15170
15171 @noindent
15172 Here is an example of its use:
15173 @lisp
15174 (service krb5-service-type
15175 (krb5-configuration
15176 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
15177 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
15178 (realms (list
15179 (krb5-realm
15180 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
15181 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
15182 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
15183 (krb5-realm
15184 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
15185 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
15186 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
15187 @end lisp
15188
15189 @noindent
15190 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
15191 @itemize
15192 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
15193 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
15194 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
15195 specified by clients;
15196 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
15197 @end itemize
15198
15199 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
15200 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
15201 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
15202 @uref{http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
15203 documentation.
15204
15205
15206 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
15207 @cindex realm, kerberos
15208 @table @asis
15209 @item @code{name}
15210 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
15211 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
15212 converted to upper case.
15213
15214 @item @code{admin-server}
15215 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
15216 running.
15217
15218 @item @code{kdc}
15219 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
15220 for the realm.
15221 @end table
15222 @end deftp
15223
15224 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
15225
15226 @table @asis
15227 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
15228 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
15229 known to be weak will be accepted.
15230
15231 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
15232 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
15233 realm for the client.
15234 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
15235 If this value is @code{#f}
15236 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
15237 such as @command{kinit}.
15238
15239 @item @code{realms}
15240 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
15241 access.
15242 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
15243 field.
15244 @end table
15245 @end deftp
15246
15247
15248 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
15249 @cindex pam-krb5
15250
15251 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
15252 management via Kerberos.
15253 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
15254 users using Kerberos.
15255
15256 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
15257 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
15258 @end defvr
15259
15260 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
15261 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module
15262 This type has the following parameters:
15263 @table @asis
15264 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
15265 The pam-krb5 package to use.
15266
15267 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
15268 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
15269 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
15270 @end table
15271 @end deftp
15272
15273
15274 @node Web Services
15275 @subsubsection Web Services
15276
15277 @cindex web
15278 @cindex www
15279 @cindex HTTP
15280 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
15281 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
15282
15283 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
15284
15285 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
15286 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
15287 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
15288 @code{https-configuration} record.
15289
15290 A simple example configuration is given below.
15291
15292 @example
15293 (service httpd-service-type
15294 (httpd-configuration
15295 (config
15296 (httpd-config-file
15297 (server-name "www.example.com")
15298 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
15299 @end example
15300
15301 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
15302 the configuration.
15303
15304 @example
15305 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
15306 (list
15307 (httpd-virtualhost
15308 "*:80"
15309 (list (string-append
15310 "ServerName "www.example.com
15311 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
15312 @end example
15313 @end deffn
15314
15315 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
15316 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
15317 given below.
15318
15319 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
15320 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
15321
15322 @table @asis
15323 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
15324 The httpd package to use.
15325
15326 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
15327 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
15328
15329 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
15330 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
15331 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
15332 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
15333 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
15334
15335 @end table
15336 @end deffn
15337
15338 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
15339 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
15340
15341 @table @asis
15342 @item @code{name}
15343 The name of the module.
15344
15345 @item @code{file}
15346 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
15347 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
15348 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
15349 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
15350
15351 @end table
15352 @end deffn
15353
15354 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
15355 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
15356
15357 @table @asis
15358 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
15359 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
15360 additional configuration.
15361
15362 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
15363 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
15364 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
15365 taken as relative to the server root.
15366
15367 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
15368 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
15369 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
15370 itself.
15371
15372 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specifyed
15373 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
15374 @code{ServerName}.
15375
15376 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
15377 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
15378
15379 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
15380 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
15381 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
15382 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
15383 protocol to use.
15384
15385 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
15386 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
15387 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
15388 configured correctly.
15389
15390 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
15391 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
15392
15393 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
15394 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
15395
15396 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
15397 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
15398
15399 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
15400 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
15401 of the configuration file.
15402
15403 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
15404 list.
15405
15406 @end table
15407 @end deffn
15408
15409 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
15410 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
15411
15412 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
15413
15414 @example
15415 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
15416 (list
15417 (httpd-virtualhost
15418 "*:80"
15419 (list (string-append
15420 "ServerName "www.example.com
15421 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
15422 @end example
15423
15424 @table @asis
15425 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
15426 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
15427
15428 @item @code{contents}
15429 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
15430 of strings and G-expressions.
15431
15432 @end table
15433 @end deffn
15434
15435 @subsubheading NGINX
15436
15437 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
15438 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
15439 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
15440
15441 A simple example configuration is given below.
15442
15443 @example
15444 (service nginx-service-type
15445 (nginx-configuration
15446 (server-blocks
15447 (list (nginx-server-configuration
15448 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
15449 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
15450 @end example
15451
15452 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
15453 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
15454 blocks, as in this example:
15455
15456 @example
15457 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
15458 (list (nginx-server-configuration
15459 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
15460 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
15461 @end example
15462 @end deffn
15463
15464 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
15465 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
15466 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
15467 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
15468 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
15469 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
15470 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
15471 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
15472
15473 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
15474 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
15475 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
15476 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
15477
15478 @table @asis
15479 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
15480 The nginx package to use.
15481
15482 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
15483 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
15484
15485 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
15486 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
15487 files.
15488
15489 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
15490 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
15491 file, the elements should be of type
15492 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
15493
15494 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
15495 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
15496 HTTPS.
15497 @example
15498 (service nginx-service-type
15499 (nginx-configuration
15500 (server-blocks
15501 (list (nginx-server-configuration
15502 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
15503 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
15504 @end example
15505
15506 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
15507 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
15508 file, the elements should be of type
15509 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
15510
15511 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
15512 when combined with @code{locations} in the
15513 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
15514 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
15515 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
15516 requests with two servers.
15517
15518 @example
15519 (service
15520 nginx-service-type
15521 (nginx-configuration
15522 (server-blocks
15523 (list (nginx-server-configuration
15524 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
15525 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
15526 (locations
15527 (list
15528 (nginx-location-configuration
15529 (uri "/path1")
15530 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
15531 (upstream-blocks
15532 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
15533 (name "server-proxy")
15534 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
15535 "server2.example.com")))))))
15536 @end example
15537
15538 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
15539 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
15540 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
15541 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
15542 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
15543 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
15544
15545 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
15546 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
15547 nginx-configuration record.
15548
15549 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
15550 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
15551 use the size of the processors cache line.
15552
15553 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
15554 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
15555
15556 @end table
15557 @end deffn
15558
15559 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
15560 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
15561 This type has the following parameters:
15562
15563 @table @asis
15564 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
15565 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
15566 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
15567 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
15568 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
15569
15570 @example
15571 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
15572 @end example
15573
15574 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
15575 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
15576 default server for connections matching no other server.
15577
15578 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
15579 Root of the website nginx will serve.
15580
15581 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
15582 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
15583 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
15584 server block.
15585
15586 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
15587 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
15588 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
15589
15590 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
15591 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
15592 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
15593
15594 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
15595 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
15596 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
15597
15598 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
15599 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
15600 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
15601
15602 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
15603 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
15604
15605 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
15606 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
15607
15608 @end table
15609 @end deftp
15610
15611 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
15612 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
15613 block. This type has the following parameters:
15614
15615 @table @asis
15616 @item @code{name}
15617 Name for this group of servers.
15618
15619 @item @code{servers}
15620 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
15621 specified as a IP address (e.g. @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
15622 (e.g. @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
15623 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
15624 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
15625 explicitly.
15626
15627 @end table
15628 @end deftp
15629
15630 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
15631 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
15632 block. This type has the following parameters:
15633
15634 @table @asis
15635 @item @code{uri}
15636 URI which this location block matches.
15637
15638 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
15639 @item @code{body}
15640 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
15641 many
15642 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
15643 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
15644 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
15645 http://upstream-name;")}.
15646
15647 @end table
15648 @end deftp
15649
15650 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
15651 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
15652 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
15653 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
15654 parameters:
15655
15656 @table @asis
15657 @item @code{name}
15658 Name to identify this location block.
15659
15660 @item @code{body}
15661 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
15662 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
15663 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
15664 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
15665
15666 @end table
15667 @end deftp
15668
15669 @cindex fastcgi
15670 @cindex fcgiwrap
15671 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
15672 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
15673 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
15674 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
15675 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
15676 support for it in Guix.
15677
15678 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
15679 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
15680 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
15681 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
15682 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
15683 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
15684
15685 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
15686 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
15687 @end defvr
15688
15689 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
15690 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} serice.
15691 This type has the following parameters:
15692 @table @asis
15693 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
15694 The fcgiwrap package to use.
15695
15696 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
15697 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
15698 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
15699 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
15700 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
15701 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
15702
15703 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
15704 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
15705 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
15706 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
15707 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
15708 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
15709
15710 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
15711 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
15712 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
15713 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end., run
15714 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
15715 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
15716 @end table
15717 @end deftp
15718
15719 @cindex php-fpm
15720 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
15721 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
15722
15723 These features include:
15724 @itemize @bullet
15725 @item Adaptive process spawning
15726 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
15727 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
15728 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
15729 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
15730 @item Stdout & stderr logging
15731 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
15732 @item Accelerated upload support
15733 @item Support for a "slowlog"
15734 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
15735 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
15736 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
15737 @end itemize
15738 ... and much more.
15739
15740 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
15741 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
15742 @end defvr
15743
15744 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
15745 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
15746 @table @asis
15747 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
15748 The php package to use.
15749 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
15750 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
15751 @table @asis
15752 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
15753 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
15754 @item @code{"port"}
15755 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
15756 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
15757 Listen on a unix socket.
15758 @end table
15759
15760 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
15761 User who will own the php worker processes.
15762 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
15763 Group of the worker processes.
15764 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
15765 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
15766 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
15767 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
15768 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
15769 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
15770 once the service has started.
15771 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
15772 Log for the php-fpm master process.
15773 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
15774 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
15775 Must be either:
15776 @table @asis
15777 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
15778 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
15779 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
15780 @end table
15781 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
15782 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
15783 and displayed in their browsers.
15784 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
15785 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
15786 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
15787 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
15788 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
15789 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
15790 An optional override of the whole configuration.
15791 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
15792 @end table
15793 @end deftp
15794
15795 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
15796 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
15797 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
15798 based on it's configured limits.
15799 @table @asis
15800 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
15801 Maximum of worker processes.
15802 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
15803 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
15804 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
15805 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
15806 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
15807 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
15808 @end table
15809 @end deftp
15810
15811 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
15812 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
15813 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
15814 are created.
15815 @table @asis
15816 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
15817 Maximum of worker processes.
15818 @end table
15819 @end deftp
15820
15821 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
15822 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
15823 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
15824 requests arrive.
15825 @table @asis
15826 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
15827 Maximum of worker processes.
15828 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
15829 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
15830 @end table
15831 @end deftp
15832
15833
15834 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-fpm-location @
15835 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
15836 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
15837 (version-major (package-version php)) @
15838 "-fpm.sock")]
15839 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
15840 @end deffn
15841
15842 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
15843 @example
15844 (services (cons* (dhcp-client-service)
15845 (service php-fpm-service-type)
15846 (service nginx-service-type
15847 (nginx-server-configuration
15848 (server-name '("example.com"))
15849 (root "/srv/http/")
15850 (locations
15851 (list (nginx-php-location)))
15852 (https-port #f)
15853 (ssl-certificate #f)
15854 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
15855 %base-services))
15856 @end example
15857
15858 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
15859 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
15860 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
15861 the hash of a user's email address.
15862
15863 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-serice @
15864 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
15865 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
15866 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
15867 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
15868 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
15869 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
15870 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
15871 @end deffn
15872
15873 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
15874 @example
15875 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
15876 #:configuration
15877 (nginx-server-configuration
15878 (server-name '("example.com"))))
15879 ...
15880 %base-services))
15881 @end example
15882
15883 @node Certificate Services
15884 @subsubsection Certificate Services
15885
15886 @cindex Web
15887 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
15888 @cindex Let's Encrypt
15889 @cindex TLS certificates
15890 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
15891 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
15892 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
15893 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
15894 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
15895 authenticity.
15896
15897 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
15898 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
15899 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
15900 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
15901 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
15902 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
15903 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
15904 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
15905 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
15906 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
15907 signature.
15908
15909 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
15910 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
15911 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
15912 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
15913 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g. reloading services, copying keys
15914 with different permissions).
15915
15916 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
15917 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
15918 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
15919 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
15920 some reason.
15921
15922 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
15923 can be found there:
15924 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
15925
15926 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
15927 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
15928 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
15929
15930 @example
15931 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
15932 (program-file
15933 "nginx-deploy-hook"
15934 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
15935 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
15936
15937 (service certbot-service-type
15938 (certbot-configuration
15939 (email "foo@@example.net")
15940 (certificates
15941 (list
15942 (certificate-configuration
15943 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
15944 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
15945 (certificate-configuration
15946 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
15947 @end example
15948
15949 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
15950 @end defvr
15951
15952 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
15953 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
15954 This type has the following parameters:
15955
15956 @table @asis
15957 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
15958 The certbot package to use.
15959
15960 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
15961 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
15962 files.
15963
15964 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
15965 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
15966 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
15967 and several @code{domains}.
15968
15969 @item @code{email}
15970 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
15971 account notifications.
15972
15973 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
15974 Size of the RSA key.
15975
15976 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
15977 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
15978 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
15979 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
15980 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
15981 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
15982 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
15983 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
15984 these nginx configuration data types.
15985
15986 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
15987 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
15988 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
15989
15990 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
15991 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
15992 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
15993
15994 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
15995 @end table
15996 @end deftp
15997
15998 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
15999 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
16000 This type has the following parameters:
16001
16002 @table @asis
16003 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
16004 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
16005 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
16006 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
16007
16008 Its default is the first provided domain.
16009
16010 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
16011 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
16012 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
16013
16014 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
16015 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
16016 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
16017 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
16018 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
16019 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
16020 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
16021 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
16022
16023 @end table
16024 @end deftp
16025
16026 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
16027 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
16028 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
16029 @node DNS Services
16030 @subsubsection DNS Services
16031 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
16032 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
16033
16034 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
16035 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
16036 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
16037 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}.
16038
16039 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
16040 and one slave, is:
16041
16042 @lisp
16043 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
16044 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
16045 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
16046 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
16047 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
16048
16049 (define master-zone
16050 (knot-zone-configuration
16051 (domain "example.org")
16052 (zone (zone-file
16053 (origin "example.org")
16054 (entries example.org.zone)))))
16055
16056 (define slave-zone
16057 (knot-zone-configuration
16058 (domain "plop.org")
16059 (dnssec-policy "default")
16060 (master (list "plop-master"))))
16061
16062 (define plop-master
16063 (knot-remote-configuration
16064 (id "plop-master")
16065 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
16066
16067 (operating-system
16068 ;; ...
16069 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
16070 (knot-configuration
16071 (remotes (list plop-master))
16072 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
16073 ;; ...
16074 %base-services)))
16075 @end lisp
16076
16077 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
16078 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
16079
16080 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
16081 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
16082 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
16083 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
16084 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
16085 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
16086 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
16087
16088 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
16089 @end deffn
16090
16091 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
16092 Data type representing a key.
16093 This type has the following parameters:
16094
16095 @table @asis
16096 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
16097 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
16098 be unique and must not be empty.
16099
16100 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
16101 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
16102 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
16103 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
16104
16105 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
16106 The secret key itself.
16107
16108 @end table
16109 @end deftp
16110
16111 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
16112 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
16113 This type has the following parameters:
16114
16115 @table @asis
16116 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
16117 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
16118 unique and must not be empty.
16119
16120 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
16121 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
16122 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
16123 address match is not required.
16124
16125 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
16126 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
16127 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
16128 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
16129
16130 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
16131 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
16132 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
16133 and @code{'update}.
16134
16135 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
16136 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
16137 false, listed actions are allowed.
16138
16139 @end table
16140 @end deftp
16141
16142 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
16143 Data type represnting a record entry in a zone file.
16144 This type has the following parameters:
16145
16146 @table @asis
16147 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
16148 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
16149 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
16150 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
16151 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
16152 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
16153
16154 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
16155 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
16156
16157 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
16158 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
16159 partially @code{"CH"}.
16160
16161 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
16162 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
16163 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
16164 defined.
16165
16166 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
16167 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
16168 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
16169 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
16170
16171 @end table
16172 @end deftp
16173
16174 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
16175 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
16176 This type has the following parameters:
16177
16178 @table @asis
16179 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
16180 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
16181 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
16182 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
16183 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
16184 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
16185 field of the @code{zone-file}.
16186
16187 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
16188 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
16189
16190 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
16191 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
16192 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
16193 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
16194 to an IP address in the list of entries.
16195
16196 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
16197 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
16198 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
16199
16200 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
16201 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
16202 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
16203 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
16204
16205 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
16206 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
16207 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
16208 @code{(string->duration)}.
16209
16210 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
16211 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
16212 to do so a first time.
16213
16214 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
16215 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
16216 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
16217 and check again that it still exists.
16218
16219 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
16220 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
16221 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
16222
16223 @end table
16224 @end deftp
16225
16226 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
16227 Data type representing a remote configuration.
16228 This type has the following parameters:
16229
16230 @table @asis
16231 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
16232 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
16233 be unique and must not be empty.
16234
16235 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
16236 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
16237 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
16238 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
16239
16240 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
16241 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
16242 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
16243 The default is to choose at random.
16244
16245 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
16246 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
16247 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
16248
16249 @end table
16250 @end deftp
16251
16252 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
16253 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
16254 This type has the following parameters:
16255
16256 @table @asis
16257 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
16258 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
16259
16260 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
16261 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
16262
16263 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
16264 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
16265 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
16266 For the pem backend, the string reprensents a path in the file system.
16267
16268 @end table
16269 @end deftp
16270
16271 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
16272 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
16273 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
16274 use keys that you generate.
16275
16276 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
16277 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
16278 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
16279 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
16280 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
16281 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
16282
16283 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
16284 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
16285 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
16286 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
16287 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
16288
16289 This type has the following parameters:
16290
16291 @table @asis
16292 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
16293 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
16294
16295 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
16296 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
16297 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
16298 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
16299 was setup by this service).
16300
16301 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
16302 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
16303
16304 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
16305 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
16306
16307 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
16308 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
16309
16310 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
16311 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
16312 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
16313
16314 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
16315 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
16316 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
16317
16318 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
16319 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
16320 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
16321
16322 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
16323 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
16324
16325 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
16326 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
16327 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
16328
16329 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
16330 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
16331
16332 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
16333 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
16334
16335 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
16336 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
16337
16338 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
16339 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
16340
16341 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
16342 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
16343 name before hashing.
16344
16345 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
16346 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
16347
16348 @end table
16349 @end deftp
16350
16351 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
16352 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
16353 This type has the following parameters:
16354
16355 @table @asis
16356 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
16357 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
16358
16359 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
16360 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
16361 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
16362
16363 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
16364 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
16365 must contain a zone-file record.
16366
16367 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
16368 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
16369 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
16370
16371 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
16372 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
16373 masters.
16374
16375 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
16376 A list of slave remote identifiers.
16377
16378 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
16379 A list of acl identifiers.
16380
16381 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
16382 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
16383
16384 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
16385 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
16386
16387 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
16388 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
16389 synchronization.
16390
16391 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
16392 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
16393
16394 @end table
16395 @end deftp
16396
16397 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
16398 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
16399 This type has the following parameters:
16400
16401 @table @asis
16402 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
16403 The Knot package.
16404
16405 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
16406 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
16407
16408 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
16409 An ip address on which to listen.
16410
16411 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
16412 An ip address on which to listen.
16413
16414 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
16415 A port on which to listen.
16416
16417 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
16418 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
16419
16420 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
16421 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
16422
16423 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
16424 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
16425
16426 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
16427 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
16428
16429 @end table
16430 @end deftp
16431
16432
16433 @node VPN Services
16434 @subsubsection VPN Services
16435 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
16436 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
16437
16438 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
16439 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
16440 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{servire} service for your machine
16441 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
16442
16443 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
16444 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
16445
16446 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
16447 @end deffn
16448
16449 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
16450 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
16451
16452 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
16453
16454 Both can be run simultaneously.
16455 @end deffn
16456
16457 @c %automatically generated documentation
16458
16459 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
16460
16461 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
16462 The OpenVPN package.
16463
16464 @end deftypevr
16465
16466 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
16467 The OpenVPN pid file.
16468
16469 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
16470
16471 @end deftypevr
16472
16473 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
16474 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
16475 servers.
16476
16477 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
16478
16479 @end deftypevr
16480
16481 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
16482 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
16483
16484 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
16485
16486 @end deftypevr
16487
16488 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
16489 The certificate authority to check connections against.
16490
16491 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
16492
16493 @end deftypevr
16494
16495 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
16496 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
16497 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
16498
16499 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
16500
16501 @end deftypevr
16502
16503 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
16504 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
16505 certificate is @code{cert}.
16506
16507 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
16508
16509 @end deftypevr
16510
16511 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
16512 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
16513
16514 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16515
16516 @end deftypevr
16517
16518 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
16519 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
16520
16521 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16522
16523 @end deftypevr
16524
16525 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
16526 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
16527 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
16528
16529 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16530
16531 @end deftypevr
16532
16533 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
16534 Verbosity level.
16535
16536 Defaults to @samp{3}.
16537
16538 @end deftypevr
16539
16540 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
16541 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
16542 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
16543
16544 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16545
16546 @end deftypevr
16547
16548 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
16549 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
16550
16551 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16552
16553 @end deftypevr
16554
16555 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
16556 Bind to a specific local port number.
16557
16558 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16559
16560 @end deftypevr
16561
16562 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
16563 Retry resolving server address.
16564
16565 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16566
16567 @end deftypevr
16568
16569 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
16570 A list of remote servers to connect to.
16571
16572 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16573
16574 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
16575
16576 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
16577 Server name.
16578
16579 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
16580
16581 @end deftypevr
16582
16583 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
16584 Port number the server listens to.
16585
16586 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
16587
16588 @end deftypevr
16589
16590 @end deftypevr
16591 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
16592
16593 @c %automatically generated documentation
16594
16595 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
16596
16597 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
16598 The OpenVPN package.
16599
16600 @end deftypevr
16601
16602 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
16603 The OpenVPN pid file.
16604
16605 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
16606
16607 @end deftypevr
16608
16609 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
16610 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
16611 servers.
16612
16613 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
16614
16615 @end deftypevr
16616
16617 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
16618 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
16619
16620 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
16621
16622 @end deftypevr
16623
16624 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
16625 The certificate authority to check connections against.
16626
16627 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
16628
16629 @end deftypevr
16630
16631 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
16632 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
16633 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
16634
16635 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
16636
16637 @end deftypevr
16638
16639 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
16640 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
16641 certificate is @code{cert}.
16642
16643 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
16644
16645 @end deftypevr
16646
16647 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
16648 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
16649
16650 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16651
16652 @end deftypevr
16653
16654 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
16655 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
16656
16657 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16658
16659 @end deftypevr
16660
16661 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
16662 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
16663 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
16664
16665 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16666
16667 @end deftypevr
16668
16669 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
16670 Verbosity level.
16671
16672 Defaults to @samp{3}.
16673
16674 @end deftypevr
16675
16676 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
16677 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
16678 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
16679
16680 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16681
16682 @end deftypevr
16683
16684 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
16685 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
16686
16687 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
16688
16689 @end deftypevr
16690
16691 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
16692 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
16693
16694 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
16695
16696 @end deftypevr
16697
16698 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
16699 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
16700
16701 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16702
16703 @end deftypevr
16704
16705 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
16706 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
16707
16708 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
16709
16710 @end deftypevr
16711
16712 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
16713 The file that records client IPs.
16714
16715 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
16716
16717 @end deftypevr
16718
16719 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
16720 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
16721
16722 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16723
16724 @end deftypevr
16725
16726 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
16727 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
16728
16729 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16730
16731 @end deftypevr
16732
16733 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
16734 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
16735 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
16736 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
16737 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
16738 down.
16739
16740 @end deftypevr
16741
16742 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
16743 The maximum number of clients.
16744
16745 Defaults to @samp{100}.
16746
16747 @end deftypevr
16748
16749 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
16750 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
16751 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
16752
16753 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
16754
16755 @end deftypevr
16756
16757 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
16758 The list of configuration for some clients.
16759
16760 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16761
16762 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
16763
16764 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
16765 Client name.
16766
16767 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
16768
16769 @end deftypevr
16770
16771 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
16772 Client own network
16773
16774 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16775
16776 @end deftypevr
16777
16778 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
16779 Client VPN IP.
16780
16781 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16782
16783 @end deftypevr
16784
16785 @end deftypevr
16786
16787
16788 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
16789
16790
16791 @node Network File System
16792 @subsubsection Network File System
16793 @cindex NFS
16794
16795 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
16796 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
16797 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
16798
16799 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
16800 @cindex rpcbind
16801
16802 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
16803 universal addresses.
16804 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
16805 started when a dependent service starts.
16806
16807 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
16808 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
16809 @end defvr
16810
16811
16812 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
16813 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
16814 This type has the following parameters:
16815 @table @asis
16816 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
16817 The rpcbind package to use.
16818
16819 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
16820 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
16821 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
16822 instance.
16823 @end table
16824 @end deftp
16825
16826
16827 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
16828 @cindex pipefs
16829 @cindex rpc_pipefs
16830
16831 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
16832 between the kernel and user space programs.
16833
16834 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
16835 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
16836 @end defvr
16837
16838 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
16839 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
16840 This type has the following parameters:
16841 @table @asis
16842 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
16843 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
16844 @end table
16845 @end deftp
16846
16847
16848 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
16849 @cindex GSSD
16850 @cindex GSS
16851 @cindex global security system
16852
16853 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
16854 based protocols.
16855 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
16856 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
16857 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
16858
16859 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
16860 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
16861 @end defvr
16862
16863 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
16864 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
16865 This type has the following parameters:
16866 @table @asis
16867 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
16868 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
16869
16870 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
16871 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
16872
16873 @end table
16874 @end deftp
16875
16876
16877 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
16878 @cindex idmapd
16879 @cindex name mapper
16880
16881 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
16882 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
16883
16884 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
16885 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
16886 @end defvr
16887
16888 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
16889 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
16890 This type has the following parameters:
16891 @table @asis
16892 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
16893 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
16894
16895 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
16896 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
16897
16898 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
16899 The local NFSv4 domain name.
16900 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
16901 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
16902
16903 @end table
16904 @end deftp
16905
16906 @node Continuous Integration
16907 @subsubsection Continuous Integration
16908
16909 @cindex continuous integration
16910 @uref{https://notabug.org/mthl/cuirass, Cuirass} is a continuous
16911 integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and for
16912 providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
16913
16914 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
16915
16916 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
16917 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
16918 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
16919 @end defvr
16920
16921 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of
16922 the configuration. Here is an example of a service defining a build job
16923 based on a specification that can be found in Cuirass source tree. This
16924 service polls the Guix repository and builds a subset of the Guix
16925 packages, as prescribed in the @file{gnu-system.scm} example spec:
16926
16927 @example
16928 (let ((spec #~((#:name . "guix")
16929 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
16930 (#:load-path . ".")
16931 (#:file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
16932 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
16933 (#:arguments (subset . "hello"))
16934 (#:branch . "master"))))
16935 (service cuirass-service-type
16936 (cuirass-configuration
16937 (specifications #~(list '#$spec)))))
16938 @end example
16939
16940 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
16941 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
16942 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
16943
16944 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
16945 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
16946
16947 @table @asis
16948 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
16949 Location of the log file.
16950
16951 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
16952 Location of the repository cache.
16953
16954 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
16955 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
16956
16957 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
16958 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
16959
16960 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
16961 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
16962 Cuirass jobs.
16963
16964 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/run/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
16965 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
16966 added specifications.
16967
16968 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
16969 Port number used by the HTTP server.
16970
16971 @item --listen=@var{host}
16972 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
16973 accept connections from localhost.
16974
16975 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
16976 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
16977 where a specification is an association list
16978 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
16979 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
16980 above.
16981
16982 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
16983 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
16984 from source.
16985
16986 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
16987 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
16988
16989 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
16990 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
16991 packages locally.
16992
16993 @item @code{load-path} (default: @code{'()})
16994 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
16995 cuirass as in @command{guix build} command.
16996
16997 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
16998 The Cuirass package to use.
16999 @end table
17000 @end deftp
17001
17002 @node Power management Services
17003 @subsubsection Power management Services
17004
17005 @cindex power management with TLP
17006 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
17007 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
17008
17009 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
17010 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
17011 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
17012 source is detected. More information can be found at
17013 @uref{http://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
17014
17015 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
17016 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
17017 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
17018 write:
17019 @example
17020 (service tlp-service-type)
17021 @end example
17022 @end deffn
17023
17024 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
17025 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
17026
17027 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
17028 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
17029 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
17030 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
17031 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
17032
17033 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
17034 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
17035 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
17036 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
17037 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
17038 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
17039 @c the churn as TLP updates.
17040
17041 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
17042
17043 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
17044 The TLP package.
17045
17046 @end deftypevr
17047
17048 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
17049 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
17050
17051 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17052
17053 @end deftypevr
17054
17055 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
17056 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
17057 and BAT.
17058
17059 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
17060
17061 @end deftypevr
17062
17063 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
17064 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
17065 before syncing on AC.
17066
17067 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17068
17069 @end deftypevr
17070
17071 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
17072 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
17073
17074 Defaults to @samp{2}.
17075
17076 @end deftypevr
17077
17078 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
17079 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
17080
17081 Defaults to @samp{15}.
17082
17083 @end deftypevr
17084
17085 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
17086 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
17087
17088 Defaults to @samp{60}.
17089
17090 @end deftypevr
17091
17092 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
17093 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
17094 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
17095 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
17096
17097 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17098
17099 @end deftypevr
17100
17101 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
17102 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
17103
17104 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17105
17106 @end deftypevr
17107
17108 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
17109 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
17110
17111 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17112
17113 @end deftypevr
17114
17115 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
17116 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
17117
17118 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17119
17120 @end deftypevr
17121
17122 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
17123 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
17124
17125 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17126
17127 @end deftypevr
17128
17129 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
17130 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
17131
17132 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17133
17134 @end deftypevr
17135
17136 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
17137 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
17138 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
17139
17140 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17141
17142 @end deftypevr
17143
17144 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
17145 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
17146 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
17147
17148 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17149
17150 @end deftypevr
17151
17152 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
17153 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
17154
17155 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17156
17157 @end deftypevr
17158
17159 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
17160 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
17161
17162 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17163
17164 @end deftypevr
17165
17166 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
17167 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
17168
17169 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17170
17171 @end deftypevr
17172
17173 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
17174 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
17175
17176 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17177
17178 @end deftypevr
17179
17180 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
17181 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
17182 used under light load conditions.
17183
17184 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17185
17186 @end deftypevr
17187
17188 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
17189 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
17190
17191 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17192
17193 @end deftypevr
17194
17195 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
17196 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
17197
17198 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17199
17200 @end deftypevr
17201
17202 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
17203 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
17204 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
17205
17206 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17207
17208 @end deftypevr
17209
17210 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
17211 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
17212 performance, normal, powersave.
17213
17214 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
17215
17216 @end deftypevr
17217
17218 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
17219 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
17220
17221 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
17222
17223 @end deftypevr
17224
17225 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
17226 Hard disk devices.
17227
17228 @end deftypevr
17229
17230 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
17231 Hard disk advanced power management level.
17232
17233 @end deftypevr
17234
17235 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
17236 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
17237
17238 @end deftypevr
17239
17240 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
17241 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
17242 declared hard disk.
17243
17244 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17245
17246 @end deftypevr
17247
17248 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
17249 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
17250
17251 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17252
17253 @end deftypevr
17254
17255 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
17256 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
17257 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
17258 noop.
17259
17260 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17261
17262 @end deftypevr
17263
17264 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
17265 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
17266 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
17267
17268 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
17269
17270 @end deftypevr
17271
17272 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
17273 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
17274
17275 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
17276
17277 @end deftypevr
17278
17279 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
17280 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
17281
17282 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17283
17284 @end deftypevr
17285
17286 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
17287 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
17288 mode.
17289
17290 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17291
17292 @end deftypevr
17293
17294 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
17295 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
17296
17297 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17298
17299 @end deftypevr
17300
17301 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
17302 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
17303
17304 Defaults to @samp{15}.
17305
17306 @end deftypevr
17307
17308 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
17309 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
17310 default, performance, powersave.
17311
17312 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
17313
17314 @end deftypevr
17315
17316 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
17317 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
17318
17319 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
17320
17321 @end deftypevr
17322
17323 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
17324 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
17325 auto, default.
17326
17327 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
17328
17329 @end deftypevr
17330
17331 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
17332 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
17333
17334 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
17335
17336 @end deftypevr
17337
17338 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
17339 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
17340 performance.
17341
17342 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
17343
17344 @end deftypevr
17345
17346 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
17347 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
17348
17349 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
17350
17351 @end deftypevr
17352
17353 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
17354 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
17355
17356 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
17357
17358 @end deftypevr
17359
17360 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
17361 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
17362
17363 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
17364
17365 @end deftypevr
17366
17367 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
17368 Wifi power saving mode.
17369
17370 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17371
17372 @end deftypevr
17373
17374 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
17375 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
17376
17377 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17378
17379 @end deftypevr
17380
17381 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
17382 Disable wake on LAN.
17383
17384 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17385
17386 @end deftypevr
17387
17388 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
17389 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
17390 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
17391
17392 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17393
17394 @end deftypevr
17395
17396 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
17397 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
17398
17399 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17400
17401 @end deftypevr
17402
17403 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
17404 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
17405
17406 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17407
17408 @end deftypevr
17409
17410 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
17411 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
17412 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
17413 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
17414
17415 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17416
17417 @end deftypevr
17418
17419 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
17420 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
17421
17422 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
17423
17424 @end deftypevr
17425
17426 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
17427 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
17428 and auto.
17429
17430 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
17431
17432 @end deftypevr
17433
17434 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
17435 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
17436
17437 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
17438
17439 @end deftypevr
17440
17441 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
17442 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
17443 ones.
17444
17445 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17446
17447 @end deftypevr
17448
17449 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
17450 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
17451
17452 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17453
17454 @end deftypevr
17455
17456 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
17457 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
17458 Power Management.
17459
17460 @end deftypevr
17461
17462 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
17463 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
17464
17465 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17466
17467 @end deftypevr
17468
17469 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
17470 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
17471
17472 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17473
17474 @end deftypevr
17475
17476 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
17477 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
17478
17479 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17480
17481 @end deftypevr
17482
17483 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
17484 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
17485 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
17486
17487 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17488
17489 @end deftypevr
17490
17491 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
17492 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
17493
17494 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17495
17496 @end deftypevr
17497
17498 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
17499 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
17500 shutdown on system startup.
17501
17502 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17503
17504 @end deftypevr
17505
17506
17507 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
17508 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
17509
17510 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
17511 This is the service type for
17512 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
17513 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
17514 of processors and preventing overheating.
17515 @end defvr
17516
17517 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
17518 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
17519
17520 @table @asis
17521 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
17522 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
17523
17524 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
17525 Package object of thermald.
17526
17527 @end table
17528 @end deftp
17529
17530 @node Audio Services
17531 @subsubsection Audio Services
17532
17533 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
17534 (the Music Player Daemon).
17535
17536 @cindex mpd
17537 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
17538
17539 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
17540 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
17541 of clients.
17542
17543 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
17544 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
17545
17546 @example
17547 (service mpd-service-type
17548 (mpd-configuration
17549 (user "bob")
17550 (port "6666")))
17551 @end example
17552
17553 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
17554 The service type for @command{mpd}
17555 @end defvr
17556
17557 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
17558 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
17559
17560 @table @asis
17561 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
17562 The user to run mpd as.
17563
17564 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
17565 The directory to scan for music files.
17566
17567 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
17568 The directory to store playlists.
17569
17570 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
17571 The port to run mpd on.
17572
17573 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
17574 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
17575 an absolute path can be specified here.
17576
17577 @end table
17578 @end deftp
17579
17580 @node Virtualization Services
17581 @subsubsection Virtualization services
17582
17583 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
17584 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
17585 services.
17586
17587 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
17588 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
17589 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
17590 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
17591
17592 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
17593 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
17594 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
17595
17596 @example
17597 (service libvirt-service-type
17598 (libvirt-configuration
17599 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
17600 (tls-port "16555")))
17601 @end example
17602 @end deffn
17603
17604 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
17605 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
17606
17607 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
17608 Libvirt package.
17609
17610 @end deftypevr
17611
17612 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
17613 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
17614 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
17615
17616 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
17617 this capability.
17618
17619 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17620
17621 @end deftypevr
17622
17623 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
17624 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
17625 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
17626
17627 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
17628 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
17629 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
17630
17631 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17632
17633 @end deftypevr
17634
17635 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
17636 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
17637 service name
17638
17639 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
17640
17641 @end deftypevr
17642
17643 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
17644 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
17645 or service name
17646
17647 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
17648
17649 @end deftypevr
17650
17651 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
17652 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
17653
17654 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
17655
17656 @end deftypevr
17657
17658 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
17659 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
17660
17661 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
17662 Avahi daemon.
17663
17664 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17665
17666 @end deftypevr
17667
17668 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
17669 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
17670 broadcast network.
17671
17672 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
17673
17674 @end deftypevr
17675
17676 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
17677 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
17678 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
17679 becoming root.
17680
17681 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
17682
17683 @end deftypevr
17684
17685 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
17686 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
17687 VM status only.
17688
17689 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
17690
17691 @end deftypevr
17692
17693 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
17694 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
17695 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
17696 everyone (eg, 0777)
17697
17698 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
17699
17700 @end deftypevr
17701
17702 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
17703 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
17704 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
17705 the access to.
17706
17707 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
17708
17709 @end deftypevr
17710
17711 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
17712 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
17713
17714 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
17715
17716 @end deftypevr
17717
17718 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
17719 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
17720 permissions allow anyone to connect
17721
17722 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
17723
17724 @end deftypevr
17725
17726 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
17727 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
17728 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
17729 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
17730
17731 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
17732
17733 @end deftypevr
17734
17735 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
17736 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
17737 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
17738 scenario.
17739
17740 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
17741
17742 @end deftypevr
17743
17744 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
17745 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
17746 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
17747 by certificates.
17748
17749 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
17750 by using 'sasl' for this option
17751
17752 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
17753
17754 @end deftypevr
17755
17756 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
17757 API access control scheme.
17758
17759 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
17760 drivers can place restrictions on this.
17761
17762 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17763
17764 @end deftypevr
17765
17766 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
17767 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
17768 loaded.
17769
17770 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17771
17772 @end deftypevr
17773
17774 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
17775 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
17776 loaded.
17777
17778 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17779
17780 @end deftypevr
17781
17782 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
17783 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
17784 is loaded.
17785
17786 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17787
17788 @end deftypevr
17789
17790 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
17791 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
17792 CRL is loaded.
17793
17794 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17795
17796 @end deftypevr
17797
17798 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
17799 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
17800
17801 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
17802 certificates.
17803
17804 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17805
17806 @end deftypevr
17807
17808 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
17809 Disable verification of client certificates.
17810
17811 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
17812 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
17813 rejected.
17814
17815 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17816
17817 @end deftypevr
17818
17819 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
17820 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
17821
17822 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17823
17824 @end deftypevr
17825
17826 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
17827 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
17828 the SASL authentication mechanism.
17829
17830 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17831
17832 @end deftypevr
17833
17834 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
17835 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
17836 usually "NORMAL" unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
17837 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
17838
17839 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
17840
17841 @end deftypevr
17842
17843 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
17844 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
17845 sockets combined.
17846
17847 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
17848
17849 @end deftypevr
17850
17851 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
17852 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
17853 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
17854 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
17855
17856 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
17857
17858 @end deftypevr
17859
17860 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
17861 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
17862 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
17863
17864 Defaults to @samp{20}.
17865
17866 @end deftypevr
17867
17868 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
17869 Number of workers to start up initially.
17870
17871 Defaults to @samp{5}.
17872
17873 @end deftypevr
17874
17875 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
17876 Maximum number of worker threads.
17877
17878 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
17879 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
17880 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
17881
17882 Defaults to @samp{20}.
17883
17884 @end deftypevr
17885
17886 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
17887 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
17888 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
17889 executed in this pool.
17890
17891 Defaults to @samp{5}.
17892
17893 @end deftypevr
17894
17895 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
17896 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
17897
17898 Defaults to @samp{20}.
17899
17900 @end deftypevr
17901
17902 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
17903 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
17904 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
17905 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
17906
17907 Defaults to @samp{5}.
17908
17909 @end deftypevr
17910
17911 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
17912 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
17913
17914 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17915
17916 @end deftypevr
17917
17918 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
17919 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
17920
17921 Defaults to @samp{5}.
17922
17923 @end deftypevr
17924
17925 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
17926 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
17927
17928 Defaults to @samp{5}.
17929
17930 @end deftypevr
17931
17932 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
17933 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
17934
17935 Defaults to @samp{5}.
17936
17937 @end deftypevr
17938
17939 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
17940 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
17941
17942 Defaults to @samp{5}.
17943
17944 @end deftypevr
17945
17946 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
17947 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
17948
17949 Defaults to @samp{3}.
17950
17951 @end deftypevr
17952
17953 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
17954 Logging filters.
17955
17956 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
17957 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
17958
17959 @itemize @bullet
17960 @item
17961 x:name
17962
17963 @item
17964 x:+name
17965
17966 @end itemize
17967
17968 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
17969 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
17970 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
17971 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
17972 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
17973 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
17974 where matching messages should be logged:
17975
17976 @itemize @bullet
17977 @item
17978 1: DEBUG
17979
17980 @item
17981 2: INFO
17982
17983 @item
17984 3: WARNING
17985
17986 @item
17987 4: ERROR
17988
17989 @end itemize
17990
17991 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
17992 need to be separated by spaces.
17993
17994 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
17995
17996 @end deftypevr
17997
17998 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
17999 Logging outputs.
18000
18001 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
18002 for an output can be:
18003
18004 @table @code
18005 @item x:stderr
18006 output goes to stderr
18007
18008 @item x:syslog:name
18009 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
18010
18011 @item x:file:file_path
18012 output to a file, with the given filepath
18013
18014 @item x:journald
18015 output to journald logging system
18016
18017 @end table
18018
18019 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
18020
18021 @itemize @bullet
18022 @item
18023 1: DEBUG
18024
18025 @item
18026 2: INFO
18027
18028 @item
18029 3: WARNING
18030
18031 @item
18032 4: ERROR
18033
18034 @end itemize
18035
18036 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
18037 spaces.
18038
18039 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
18040
18041 @end deftypevr
18042
18043 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
18044 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
18045
18046 @itemize @bullet
18047 @item
18048 0: disable all auditing
18049
18050 @item
18051 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
18052
18053 @item
18054 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
18055
18056 @end itemize
18057
18058 Defaults to @samp{1}.
18059
18060 @end deftypevr
18061
18062 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
18063 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
18064
18065 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18066
18067 @end deftypevr
18068
18069 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
18070 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
18071
18072 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18073
18074 @end deftypevr
18075
18076 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
18077 Source to read host UUID.
18078
18079 @itemize @bullet
18080 @item
18081 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
18082
18083 @item
18084 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
18085
18086 @end itemize
18087
18088 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
18089 be generated.
18090
18091 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
18092
18093 @end deftypevr
18094
18095 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
18096 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
18097 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
18098 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
18099 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
18100
18101 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18102
18103 @end deftypevr
18104
18105 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
18106 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
18107 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
18108 broken.
18109
18110 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
18111 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
18112 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
18113 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
18114 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
18115 keepalive messages.
18116
18117 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18118
18119 @end deftypevr
18120
18121 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
18122 Same as above but for admin interface.
18123
18124 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18125
18126 @end deftypevr
18127
18128 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
18129 Same as above but for admin interface.
18130
18131 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18132
18133 @end deftypevr
18134
18135 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
18136 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
18137
18138 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
18139 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
18140 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
18141
18142 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18143
18144 @end deftypevr
18145
18146 @c %end of autogenerated docs
18147
18148 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
18149 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
18150 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
18151
18152 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
18153 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
18154 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
18155 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
18156 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
18157
18158 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
18159 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
18160 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
18161
18162 @example
18163 (service virtlog-service-type
18164 (virtlog-configuration
18165 (max-clients 1000)))
18166 @end example
18167 @end deffn
18168
18169 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
18170 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
18171
18172 Defaults to @samp{3}.
18173
18174 @end deftypevr
18175
18176 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
18177 Logging filters.
18178
18179 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
18180 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
18181
18182 @itemize @bullet
18183 @item
18184 x:name
18185
18186 @item
18187 x:+name
18188
18189 @end itemize
18190
18191 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
18192 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
18193 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
18194 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
18195 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
18196 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
18197 where matching messages should be logged:
18198
18199 @itemize @bullet
18200 @item
18201 1: DEBUG
18202
18203 @item
18204 2: INFO
18205
18206 @item
18207 3: WARNING
18208
18209 @item
18210 4: ERROR
18211
18212 @end itemize
18213
18214 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
18215 need to be separated by spaces.
18216
18217 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
18218
18219 @end deftypevr
18220
18221 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
18222 Logging outputs.
18223
18224 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
18225 for an output can be:
18226
18227 @table @code
18228 @item x:stderr
18229 output goes to stderr
18230
18231 @item x:syslog:name
18232 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
18233
18234 @item x:file:file_path
18235 output to a file, with the given filepath
18236
18237 @item x:journald
18238 output to journald logging system
18239
18240 @end table
18241
18242 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
18243
18244 @itemize @bullet
18245 @item
18246 1: DEBUG
18247
18248 @item
18249 2: INFO
18250
18251 @item
18252 3: WARNING
18253
18254 @item
18255 4: ERROR
18256
18257 @end itemize
18258
18259 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
18260 spaces.
18261
18262 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
18263
18264 @end deftypevr
18265
18266 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
18267 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
18268 sockets combined.
18269
18270 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
18271
18272 @end deftypevr
18273
18274 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
18275 Maximum file size before rolling over.
18276
18277 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
18278
18279 @end deftypevr
18280
18281 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
18282 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
18283
18284 Defaults to @samp{3}
18285
18286 @end deftypevr
18287
18288 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
18289
18290 @cindex emulation
18291 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
18292 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
18293 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
18294 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
18295 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
18296 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
18297
18298 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
18299 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
18300 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
18301 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
18302 emulated:
18303
18304 @example
18305 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
18306 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
18307 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64" "ppc"))))
18308 @end example
18309
18310 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
18311 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
18312 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
18313 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
18314 @end defvr
18315
18316 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
18317 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
18318
18319 @table @asis
18320 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
18321 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
18322 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
18323
18324 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
18325 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
18326 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
18327 @code{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
18328 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
18329 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
18330
18331 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
18332 service:
18333
18334 @example
18335 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
18336 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
18337 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
18338 (guix-support? #t)))
18339 @end example
18340
18341 You can run:
18342
18343 @example
18344 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
18345 @end example
18346
18347 @noindent
18348 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
18349 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
18350 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
18351 access to!
18352
18353 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
18354 The QEMU package to use.
18355 @end table
18356 @end deftp
18357
18358 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
18359 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
18360 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
18361 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
18362 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
18363 @end deffn
18364
18365 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
18366 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
18367 @end deffn
18368
18369 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
18370 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
18371 @end deffn
18372
18373 @node Version Control Services
18374 @subsubsection Version Control Services
18375
18376 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
18377 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
18378 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
18379 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
18380 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
18381 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
18382 @code{cgit-service-type}.
18383
18384 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
18385
18386 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
18387 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
18388
18389 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
18390 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
18391 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
18392 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
18393 @file{/srv/git}.
18394
18395 @end deffn
18396
18397 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
18398 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
18399
18400 @table @asis
18401 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
18402 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
18403
18404 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
18405 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
18406 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
18407
18408 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
18409 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
18410 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
18411 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
18412 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
18413
18414 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
18415 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
18416 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
18417 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
18418 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
18419 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
18420 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
18421
18422 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
18423 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
18424 all.
18425
18426 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
18427 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
18428
18429 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
18430 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
18431
18432 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
18433 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
18434 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
18435
18436 @end table
18437 @end deftp
18438
18439 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
18440 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know that the data you
18441 receive was modified is really coming from the specified host, and you
18442 have your connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an
18443 authenticated and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
18444 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
18445 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
18446 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
18447 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
18448 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
18449
18450 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
18451 over HTTP.
18452
18453 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
18454 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-http-service}.
18455
18456 @table @asis
18457 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
18458 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
18459
18460 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
18461 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
18462
18463 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
18464 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
18465 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
18466
18467 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @file{/git/})
18468 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @code{/git/} prefix, this
18469 will map @code{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
18470 @code{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
18471 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
18472
18473 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
18474 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
18475 Services}.
18476 @end table
18477 @end deftp
18478
18479 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
18480 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
18481 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
18482 server.
18483
18484 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
18485 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
18486 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
18487 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
18488 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
18489
18490 @example
18491 (service nginx-service-type
18492 (nginx-configuration
18493 (server-blocks
18494 (list
18495 (nginx-server-configuration
18496 (listen '("443 ssl"))
18497 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
18498 (ssl-certificate
18499 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
18500 (ssl-certificate-key
18501 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
18502 (locations
18503 (list
18504 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
18505 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
18506 @end example
18507
18508 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
18509 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
18510 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
18511 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
18512 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
18513 @end deffn
18514
18515 @subsubheading Cgit Service
18516
18517 @cindex Cgit service
18518 @cindex Git, web interface
18519 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
18520 repositories written in C.
18521
18522 The following example will configure the service with default values.
18523 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
18524
18525 @example
18526 (service cgit-service-type)
18527 @end example
18528
18529 @c %start of fragment
18530
18531 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
18532
18533 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
18534 The CGIT package.
18535
18536 @end deftypevr
18537
18538 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
18539 NGINX configuration.
18540
18541 @end deftypevr
18542
18543 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string about-filter
18544 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
18545 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
18546
18547 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18548
18549 @end deftypevr
18550
18551 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
18552 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
18553 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
18554
18555 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18556
18557 @end deftypevr
18558
18559 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string auth-filter
18560 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
18561 access.
18562
18563 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18564
18565 @end deftypevr
18566
18567 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
18568 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
18569 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
18570
18571 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
18572
18573 @end deftypevr
18574
18575 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
18576 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
18577
18578 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
18579
18580 @end deftypevr
18581
18582 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
18583 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
18584 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
18585
18586 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
18587
18588 @end deftypevr
18589
18590 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
18591 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
18592 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
18593
18594 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18595
18596 @end deftypevr
18597
18598 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
18599 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
18600 version of the repository summary page.
18601
18602 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18603
18604 @end deftypevr
18605
18606 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
18607 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
18608 version of the repository index page.
18609
18610 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18611
18612 @end deftypevr
18613
18614 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
18615 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
18616 scanning a path for Git repositories.
18617
18618 Defaults to @samp{15}.
18619
18620 @end deftypevr
18621
18622 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
18623 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
18624 version of the repository about page.
18625
18626 Defaults to @samp{15}.
18627
18628 @end deftypevr
18629
18630 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
18631 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
18632 version of snapshots.
18633
18634 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18635
18636 @end deftypevr
18637
18638 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
18639 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
18640 caching is disabled.
18641
18642 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18643
18644 @end deftypevr
18645
18646 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
18647 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
18648
18649 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18650
18651 @end deftypevr
18652
18653 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
18654 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
18655 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
18656
18657 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18658
18659 @end deftypevr
18660
18661 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
18662 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
18663
18664 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18665
18666 @end deftypevr
18667
18668 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-filter
18669 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
18670
18671 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18672
18673 @end deftypevr
18674
18675 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
18676 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
18677 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
18678 ordering.
18679
18680 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
18681
18682 @end deftypevr
18683
18684 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string css
18685 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
18686
18687 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
18688
18689 @end deftypevr
18690
18691 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string email-filter
18692 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
18693 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
18694 places throughout the cgit interface.
18695
18696 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18697
18698 @end deftypevr
18699
18700 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
18701 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
18702 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
18703
18704 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18705
18706 @end deftypevr
18707
18708 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
18709 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
18710 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
18711 repository log page.
18712
18713 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18714
18715 @end deftypevr
18716
18717 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
18718 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
18719 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
18720
18721 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18722
18723 @end deftypevr
18724
18725 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
18726 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
18727 log view.
18728
18729 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18730
18731 @end deftypevr
18732
18733 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
18734 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
18735 clones.
18736
18737 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18738
18739 @end deftypevr
18740
18741 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
18742 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
18743 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
18744
18745 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18746
18747 @end deftypevr
18748
18749 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
18750 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
18751 each repo in the repository index.
18752
18753 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18754
18755 @end deftypevr
18756
18757 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
18758 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
18759 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
18760
18761 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18762
18763 @end deftypevr
18764
18765 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
18766 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
18767 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
18768
18769 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18770
18771 @end deftypevr
18772
18773 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
18774 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
18775 branches in the summary and refs views.
18776
18777 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18778
18779 @end deftypevr
18780
18781 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
18782 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
18783 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
18784 commit view.
18785
18786 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18787
18788 @end deftypevr
18789
18790 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
18791 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
18792 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
18793 commit view.
18794
18795 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18796
18797 @end deftypevr
18798
18799 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
18800 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
18801 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
18802
18803 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18804
18805 @end deftypevr
18806
18807 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
18808 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
18809 set any repo specific settings.
18810
18811 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18812
18813 @end deftypevr
18814
18815 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string favicon
18816 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
18817
18818 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
18819
18820 @end deftypevr
18821
18822 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
18823 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
18824 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e. it replaces the standard
18825 "generated by..." message).
18826
18827 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18828
18829 @end deftypevr
18830
18831 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
18832 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
18833 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
18834
18835 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18836
18837 @end deftypevr
18838
18839 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
18840 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
18841 verbatim at the top of all pages.
18842
18843 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18844
18845 @end deftypevr
18846
18847 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string include
18848 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
18849 file is parsed.
18850
18851 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18852
18853 @end deftypevr
18854
18855 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
18856 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
18857 verbatim above the repository index.
18858
18859 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18860
18861 @end deftypevr
18862
18863 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
18864 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
18865 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
18866
18867 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18868
18869 @end deftypevr
18870
18871 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
18872 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
18873 in the servers timezone.
18874
18875 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18876
18877 @end deftypevr
18878
18879 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo
18880 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
18881 on all cgit pages.
18882
18883 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
18884
18885 @end deftypevr
18886
18887 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
18888 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
18889
18890 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18891
18892 @end deftypevr
18893
18894 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string owner-filter
18895 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
18896 page.
18897
18898 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18899
18900 @end deftypevr
18901
18902 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
18903 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
18904
18905 Defaults to @samp{10}.
18906
18907 @end deftypevr
18908
18909 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
18910 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
18911
18912 Defaults to @samp{50}.
18913
18914 @end deftypevr
18915
18916 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
18917 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
18918
18919 Defaults to @samp{80}.
18920
18921 @end deftypevr
18922
18923 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
18924 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
18925 page.
18926
18927 Defaults to @samp{50}.
18928
18929 @end deftypevr
18930
18931 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
18932 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
18933 on the repository index page.
18934
18935 Defaults to @samp{80}.
18936
18937 @end deftypevr
18938
18939 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
18940 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
18941
18942 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18943
18944 @end deftypevr
18945
18946 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
18947 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
18948 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
18949
18950 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18951
18952 @end deftypevr
18953
18954 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
18955 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
18956
18957 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
18958 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
18959 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
18960
18961 @end deftypevr
18962
18963 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string mimetype-file
18964 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
18965
18966 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18967
18968 @end deftypevr
18969
18970 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
18971 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
18972 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
18973
18974 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18975
18976 @end deftypevr
18977
18978 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
18979 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
18980
18981 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18982
18983 @end deftypevr
18984
18985 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
18986 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
18987 disabled.
18988
18989 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18990
18991 @end deftypevr
18992
18993 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
18994 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
18995 header on all pages.
18996
18997 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18998
18999 @end deftypevr
19000
19001 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string readme
19002 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
19003
19004 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19005
19006 @end deftypevr
19007
19008 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
19009 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
19010 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
19011 removed for the URL and name.
19012
19013 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19014
19015 @end deftypevr
19016
19017 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
19018 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
19019
19020 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
19021
19022 @end deftypevr
19023
19024 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
19025 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
19026
19027 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19028
19029 @end deftypevr
19030
19031 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
19032 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
19033
19034 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
19035
19036 @end deftypevr
19037
19038 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
19039 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
19040
19041 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
19042
19043 @end deftypevr
19044
19045 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
19046 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
19047 verbatim below thef "about" link on the repository index page.
19048
19049 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19050
19051 @end deftypevr
19052
19053 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
19054 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
19055
19056 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19057
19058 @end deftypevr
19059
19060 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
19061 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
19062 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
19063 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
19064 directories, considered as "hidden". Note that this does not apply to
19065 the ".git" directory in non-bare repos.
19066
19067 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19068
19069 @end deftypevr
19070
19071 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
19072 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
19073 generates links for.
19074
19075 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19076
19077 @end deftypevr
19078
19079 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
19080 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
19081 @code{scan-path}).
19082
19083 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
19084
19085 @end deftypevr
19086
19087 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
19088 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
19089 after this option will inherit the current section name.
19090
19091 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19092
19093 @end deftypevr
19094
19095 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
19096 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
19097 repository listing by name.
19098
19099 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19100
19101 @end deftypevr
19102
19103 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
19104 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
19105 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
19106
19107 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19108
19109 @end deftypevr
19110
19111 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
19112 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
19113 default.
19114
19115 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19116
19117 @end deftypevr
19118
19119 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string source-filter
19120 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
19121 the tree view.
19122
19123 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19124
19125 @end deftypevr
19126
19127 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
19128 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository "summary"
19129 view.
19130
19131 Defaults to @samp{10}.
19132
19133 @end deftypevr
19134
19135 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
19136 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
19137 "summary" view.
19138
19139 Defaults to @samp{10}.
19140
19141 @end deftypevr
19142
19143 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
19144 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository "summary"
19145 view.
19146
19147 Defaults to @samp{10}.
19148
19149 @end deftypevr
19150
19151 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
19152 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
19153 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
19154
19155 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19156
19157 @end deftypevr
19158
19159 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
19160 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
19161
19162 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
19163
19164 @end deftypevr
19165
19166 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
19167 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
19168
19169 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19170
19171 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
19172
19173 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
19174 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
19175 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
19176
19177 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19178
19179 @end deftypevr
19180
19181 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string source-filter
19182 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
19183
19184 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19185
19186 @end deftypevr
19187
19188 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
19189 The relative URL used to access the repository.
19190
19191 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19192
19193 @end deftypevr
19194
19195 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string about-filter
19196 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
19197
19198 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19199
19200 @end deftypevr
19201
19202 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
19203 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
19204 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
19205
19206 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19207
19208 @end deftypevr
19209
19210 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
19211 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
19212
19213 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19214
19215 @end deftypevr
19216
19217 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-filter
19218 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
19219
19220 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19221
19222 @end deftypevr
19223
19224 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
19225 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
19226 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
19227 ordering.
19228
19229 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19230
19231 @end deftypevr
19232
19233 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
19234 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
19235 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
19236 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or "master" if
19237 there is no suitable HEAD.
19238
19239 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19240
19241 @end deftypevr
19242
19243 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
19244 The value to show as repository description.
19245
19246 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19247
19248 @end deftypevr
19249
19250 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
19251 The value to show as repository homepage.
19252
19253 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19254
19255 @end deftypevr
19256
19257 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string email-filter
19258 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
19259
19260 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19261
19262 @end deftypevr
19263
19264 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
19265 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
19266 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
19267
19268 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19269
19270 @end deftypevr
19271
19272 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
19273 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
19274 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
19275
19276 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19277
19278 @end deftypevr
19279
19280 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
19281 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
19282 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
19283
19284 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19285
19286 @end deftypevr
19287
19288 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
19289 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
19290 branches in the summary and refs views.
19291
19292 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19293
19294 @end deftypevr
19295
19296 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
19297 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
19298 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
19299
19300 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19301
19302 @end deftypevr
19303
19304 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
19305 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
19306 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
19307
19308 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19309
19310 @end deftypevr
19311
19312 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
19313 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
19314 repository index.
19315
19316 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19317
19318 @end deftypevr
19319
19320 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
19321 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
19322
19323 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19324
19325 @end deftypevr
19326
19327 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo
19328 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
19329 on this repo’s pages.
19330
19331 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19332
19333 @end deftypevr
19334
19335 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
19336 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
19337
19338 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19339
19340 @end deftypevr
19341
19342 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner-filter
19343 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
19344
19345 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19346
19347 @end deftypevr
19348
19349 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
19350 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
19351 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
19352 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
19353
19354 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19355
19356 @end deftypevr
19357
19358 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
19359 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
19360 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
19361 listing.
19362
19363 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19364
19365 @end deftypevr
19366
19367 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
19368 Override the default maximum statistics period.
19369
19370 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19371
19372 @end deftypevr
19373
19374 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
19375 The value to show as repository name.
19376
19377 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19378
19379 @end deftypevr
19380
19381 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
19382 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
19383
19384 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19385
19386 @end deftypevr
19387
19388 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
19389 An absolute path to the repository directory.
19390
19391 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19392
19393 @end deftypevr
19394
19395 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
19396 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
19397 the "About" page for this repo.
19398
19399 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19400
19401 @end deftypevr
19402
19403 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
19404 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
19405 after this option will inherit the current section name.
19406
19407 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19408
19409 @end deftypevr
19410
19411 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
19412 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
19413
19414 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19415
19416 @end deftypevr
19417
19418 @end deftypevr
19419
19420 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
19421 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
19422
19423 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19424
19425 @end deftypevr
19426
19427 @c %end of fragment
19428
19429 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
19430 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
19431 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
19432 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
19433
19434 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
19435
19436 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
19437 The cgit package.
19438 @end deftypevr
19439
19440 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
19441 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
19442 @end deftypevr
19443
19444 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
19445 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
19446
19447 @example
19448 (service cgit-service-type
19449 (opaque-cgit-configuration
19450 (cgitrc "")))
19451 @end example
19452
19453
19454 @node Game Services
19455 @subsubsection Game Services
19456
19457 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
19458 @cindex wesnothd
19459 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
19460 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
19461 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
19462
19463 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
19464 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
19465 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
19466 configuration, instantiate it as:
19467
19468 @example
19469 (service wesnothd-service-type)
19470 @end example
19471 @end defvar
19472
19473 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
19474 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
19475
19476 @table @asis
19477 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
19478 The wesnoth server package to use.
19479
19480 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
19481 The port to bind the server to.
19482 @end table
19483 @end deftp
19484
19485 @node Miscellaneous Services
19486 @subsubsection Miscellaneous Services
19487
19488 @cindex sysctl
19489 @subsubheading System Control Service
19490
19491 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
19492 parameters at boot.
19493
19494 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
19495 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
19496 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
19497 instantiated as:
19498
19499 @example
19500 (service sysctl-service-type
19501 (sysctl-configuration
19502 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
19503 @end example
19504 @end defvr
19505
19506 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
19507 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
19508
19509 @table @asis
19510 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
19511 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
19512
19513 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
19514 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
19515 @end table
19516 @end deftp
19517
19518 @cindex lirc
19519 @subsubheading Lirc Service
19520
19521 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
19522
19523 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
19524 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
19525 [#:extra-options '()]
19526 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
19527 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
19528
19529 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
19530 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
19531 for details.
19532
19533 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
19534 passed to @command{lircd}.
19535 @end deffn
19536
19537 @cindex spice
19538 @subsubheading Spice Service
19539
19540 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
19541
19542 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
19543 Returns a service that runs @url{http://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
19544 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
19545 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
19546 @end deffn
19547
19548 @subsubsection Dictionary Services
19549 @cindex dictionary
19550 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
19551
19552 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
19553 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
19554 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
19555
19556 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
19557 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
19558 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
19559
19560 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
19561 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
19562 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
19563 @end deffn
19564
19565 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
19566 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
19567
19568 @table @asis
19569 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
19570 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
19571
19572 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
19573 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
19574 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
19575 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
19576
19577 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
19578 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
19579
19580 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
19581 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
19582 @end table
19583 @end deftp
19584
19585 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
19586 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
19587
19588 @table @asis
19589 @item @code{name}
19590 Name of the handler (module instance).
19591
19592 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
19593 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
19594 the module has the same name as the handler.
19595 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
19596
19597 @item @code{options}
19598 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
19599 @end table
19600 @end deftp
19601
19602 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
19603 Data type representing a dictionary database.
19604
19605 @table @asis
19606 @item @code{name}
19607 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
19608
19609 @item @code{handler}
19610 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
19611 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
19612
19613 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
19614 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
19615 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
19616
19617 @item @code{options}
19618 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
19619 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
19620 @end table
19621 @end deftp
19622
19623 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
19624 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
19625 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
19626 @end defvr
19627
19628 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
19629
19630 @example
19631 (dicod-service #:config
19632 (dicod-configuration
19633 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
19634 (name "wordnet")
19635 (module "dictorg")
19636 (options
19637 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
19638 (databases (list (dicod-database
19639 (name "wordnet")
19640 (complex? #t)
19641 (handler "wordnet")
19642 (options '("database=wn")))
19643 %dicod-database:gcide))))
19644 @end example
19645
19646 @node Setuid Programs
19647 @subsection Setuid Programs
19648
19649 @cindex setuid programs
19650 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
19651 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
19652 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
19653 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
19654 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
19655 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
19656 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
19657 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
19658 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
19659
19660 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
19661 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
19662 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
19663 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
19664 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
19665 should be setuid root.
19666
19667 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
19668 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
19669 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
19670 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
19671 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
19672
19673 @example
19674 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
19675 @end example
19676
19677 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
19678 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
19679
19680 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
19681 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
19682
19683 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
19684 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
19685 @end defvr
19686
19687 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
19688 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
19689 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
19690 store.
19691
19692 @node X.509 Certificates
19693 @subsection X.509 Certificates
19694
19695 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
19696 @cindex X.509 certificates
19697 @cindex TLS
19698 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
19699 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
19700 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
19701 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
19702 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
19703 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
19704
19705 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
19706 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
19707 out-of-the-box.
19708
19709 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
19710 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
19711 certificates can be found.
19712
19713 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
19714 In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
19715 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
19716 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
19717 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
19718 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
19719
19720 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
19721 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
19722 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
19723 to the certificates installed globally.
19724
19725 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
19726 can also install their own certificate package in
19727 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
19728 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
19729 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
19730 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
19731 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
19732 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
19733 would typically run something like:
19734
19735 @example
19736 $ guix package -i nss-certs
19737 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
19738 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
19739 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
19740 @end example
19741
19742 As another example, R requires the @code{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
19743 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
19744 something like this:
19745
19746 @example
19747 $ guix package -i nss-certs
19748 $ export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
19749 @end example
19750
19751 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
19752 variable in the relevant documentation.
19753
19754
19755 @node Name Service Switch
19756 @subsection Name Service Switch
19757
19758 @cindex name service switch
19759 @cindex NSS
19760 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
19761 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
19762 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
19763 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
19764 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
19765 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
19766 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
19767 C Library Reference Manual}).
19768
19769 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
19770 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
19771 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
19772 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
19773 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
19774 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
19775
19776 @cindex nss-mdns
19777 @cindex .local, host name lookup
19778 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
19779 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
19780 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
19781 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
19782
19783 @example
19784 (name-service-switch
19785 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
19786
19787 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
19788 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
19789 (name-service
19790 (name "mdns_minimal")
19791
19792 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
19793 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
19794 ;; no need to try the next methods.
19795 (reaction (lookup-specification
19796 (not-found => return))))
19797
19798 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
19799 (name-service
19800 (name "dns"))
19801
19802 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
19803 (name-service
19804 (name "mdns")))))
19805 @end example
19806
19807 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
19808 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
19809 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
19810
19811 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
19812 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
19813 you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
19814 @code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
19815 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
19816 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
19817 @code{nscd-service}}).
19818
19819 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
19820 configurations.
19821
19822 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
19823 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
19824 @code{name-service-switch} object.
19825 @end defvr
19826
19827 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
19828 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
19829 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
19830 @end defvr
19831
19832 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
19833 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
19834 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
19835 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
19836 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
19837 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
19838 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
19839 run @command{guix system}.
19840
19841 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
19842
19843 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
19844 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
19845 system databases.
19846
19847 @table @code
19848 @item aliases
19849 @itemx ethers
19850 @itemx group
19851 @itemx gshadow
19852 @itemx hosts
19853 @itemx initgroups
19854 @itemx netgroup
19855 @itemx networks
19856 @itemx password
19857 @itemx public-key
19858 @itemx rpc
19859 @itemx services
19860 @itemx shadow
19861 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
19862 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
19863 @end table
19864 @end deftp
19865
19866 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
19867
19868 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
19869 associated lookup action.
19870
19871 @table @code
19872 @item name
19873 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
19874 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
19875
19876 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
19877 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
19878 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
19879 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
19880
19881 @item reaction
19882 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
19883 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
19884 Reference Manual}). For example:
19885
19886 @example
19887 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
19888 (success => return))
19889 @end example
19890 @end table
19891 @end deftp
19892
19893 @node Initial RAM Disk
19894 @subsection Initial RAM Disk
19895
19896 @cindex initrd
19897 @cindex initial RAM disk
19898 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
19899 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
19900 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
19901 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
19902 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
19903
19904 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
19905 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
19906 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
19907 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
19908 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
19909 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
19910 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
19911 file system, you would write:
19912
19913 @example
19914 (operating-system
19915 ;; @dots{}
19916 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
19917 @end example
19918
19919 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
19920 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
19921 @end defvr
19922
19923 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
19924 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
19925 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
19926 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
19927 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
19928 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
19929
19930 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
19931 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
19932 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
19933 system declaration like this:
19934
19935 @example
19936 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
19937 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
19938 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
19939 (apply base-initrd file-systems
19940 #:qemu-networking? #t
19941 rest)))
19942 @end example
19943
19944 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
19945 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
19946 volatile root file system.
19947
19948 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
19949 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
19950 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
19951 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
19952 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
19953 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
19954
19955 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
19956 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
19957 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
19958 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
19959
19960 @table @code
19961 @item --load=@var{boot}
19962 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
19963 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
19964
19965 GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
19966 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
19967 initialization system.
19968
19969 @item --root=@var{root}
19970 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
19971 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system
19972 UUID.
19973
19974 @item --system=@var{system}
19975 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
19976 @var{system}.
19977
19978 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
19979 @cindex module, black-listing
19980 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
19981 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
19982 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
19983 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
19984 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
19985
19986 @item --repl
19987 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
19988 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
19989 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
19990 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
19991 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
19992
19993 @end table
19994
19995 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
19996 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
19997 here is how to use it and customize it further.
19998
19999 @cindex initrd
20000 @cindex initial RAM disk
20001 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
20002 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
20003 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
20004 Return a monadic derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
20005 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
20006 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
20007 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
20008 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
20009 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
20010 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
20011 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
20012 the root file system.
20013
20014 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
20015 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
20016 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
20017
20018 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
20019 to it are lost.
20020 @end deffn
20021
20022 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
20023 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]@
20024 [#:linux-modules '()]
20025 Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd, with kernel
20026 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
20027 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
20028 on the kernel command line via @code{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
20029 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
20030
20031 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
20032
20033 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
20034 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
20035 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
20036 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
20037 @end deffn
20038
20039 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
20040 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
20041 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
20042 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
20043 program to run in that initrd.
20044
20045 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
20046 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
20047 Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
20048 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
20049 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
20050 automatically copied to the initrd.
20051 @end deffn
20052
20053 @node Bootloader Configuration
20054 @subsection Bootloader Configuration
20055
20056 @cindex bootloader
20057 @cindex boot loader
20058
20059 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
20060 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
20061 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
20062 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
20063 installed.
20064
20065 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
20066 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
20067 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
20068 field.
20069
20070 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
20071 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
20072
20073 @table @asis
20074
20075 @item @code{bootloader}
20076 @cindex EFI, bootloader
20077 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
20078 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
20079 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
20080 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
20081 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
20082 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
20083 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI).
20084
20085 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
20086 modules.
20087
20088 @item @code{target}
20089 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
20090 bootloader. The exact interpretation depends on the bootloader in
20091 question; for @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device
20092 name understood by the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as
20093 @code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (for GRUB, @pxref{Invoking
20094 grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
20095 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the path to a mounted EFI file
20096 system.
20097
20098 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
20099 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
20100 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
20101 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
20102
20103 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
20104 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
20105 current system.
20106
20107 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
20108 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
20109 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
20110
20111 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
20112 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
20113 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
20114 for GRUB.
20115
20116 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'gfxterm})
20117 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
20118 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
20119 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
20120 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
20121 corresponds to the GRUB variable GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT (@pxref{Simple
20122 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
20123
20124 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
20125 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
20126 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
20127 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
20128 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
20129 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
20130 GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
20131 manual}).
20132
20133 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
20134 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
20135 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
20136 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
20137
20138 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
20139 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
20140 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
20141 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
20142 @end table
20143
20144 @end deftp
20145
20146 @cindex dual boot
20147 @cindex boot menu
20148 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
20149 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
20150 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
20151 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
20152 along these lines:
20153
20154 @example
20155 (menu-entry
20156 (label "The Other Distro")
20157 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
20158 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
20159 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
20160 @end example
20161
20162 Details below.
20163
20164 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
20165 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
20166
20167 @table @asis
20168
20169 @item @code{label}
20170 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
20171
20172 @item @code{linux}
20173 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
20174
20175 @example
20176 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
20177 @end example
20178
20179 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
20180 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
20181 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
20182
20183 @example
20184 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
20185 @end example
20186
20187 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
20188 field is ignored entirely.
20189
20190 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
20191 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
20192 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
20193
20194 @item @code{initrd}
20195 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
20196 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
20197 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
20198 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
20199 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
20200
20201 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
20202 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
20203 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
20204 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
20205 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
20206
20207 @end table
20208 @end deftp
20209
20210 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
20211 Fow now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
20212 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not documented yet.
20213
20214 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
20215 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
20216 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
20217 record.
20218
20219 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
20220 logos.
20221 @end defvr
20222
20223
20224 @node Invoking guix system
20225 @subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
20226
20227 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
20228 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
20229 system} command. The synopsis is:
20230
20231 @example
20232 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
20233 @end example
20234
20235 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
20236 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
20237 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
20238 supported:
20239
20240 @table @code
20241 @item search
20242 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
20243 expressions, sorted by relevance:
20244
20245 @example
20246 $ guix system search console font
20247 name: console-fonts
20248 location: gnu/services/base.scm:729:2
20249 extends: shepherd-root
20250 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are
20251 + per virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list
20252 + of tty/font pairs like:
20253 +
20254 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16"))
20255 relevance: 20
20256
20257 name: mingetty
20258 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1048:2
20259 extends: shepherd-root
20260 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
20261 relevance: 2
20262
20263 name: login
20264 location: gnu/services/base.scm:775:2
20265 extends: pam
20266 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
20267 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
20268 relevance: 2
20269
20270 @dots{}
20271 @end example
20272
20273 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
20274 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
20275 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
20276
20277 @item reconfigure
20278 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
20279 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
20280 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
20281 systems already running GuixSD.}.
20282
20283 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
20284 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
20285 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
20286 currently running; if a service is currently running, it does not
20287 attempt to upgrade it since this would not be possible without stopping it
20288 first.
20289
20290 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
20291 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
20292 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
20293 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
20294 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
20295
20296 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
20297 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
20298 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
20299 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
20300
20301 @quotation Note
20302 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
20303 @c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
20304 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
20305 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
20306 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
20307 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
20308 @end quotation
20309
20310 @item switch-generation
20311 @cindex generations
20312 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
20313 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
20314 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
20315 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
20316 and it moves the entries for the other generatiors to a submenu, if
20317 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
20318 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
20319
20320 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
20321 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
20322 configuration file.
20323
20324 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
20325 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
20326 generation 7:
20327
20328 @example
20329 guix system switch-generation 7
20330 @end example
20331
20332 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
20333 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
20334 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
20335 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
20336 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
20337 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
20338
20339 @example
20340 guix system switch-generation -- -1
20341 @end example
20342
20343 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
20344 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
20345 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
20346 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
20347 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
20348 like activating and deactivating services.
20349
20350 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
20351
20352 @item roll-back
20353 @cindex rolling back
20354 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
20355 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
20356 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
20357 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
20358
20359 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
20360 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
20361 generation.
20362
20363 @item build
20364 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
20365 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
20366 This action does not actually install anything.
20367
20368 @item init
20369 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
20370 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
20371 installations of GuixSD. For instance:
20372
20373 @example
20374 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
20375 @end example
20376
20377 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
20378 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
20379 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
20380 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
20381 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
20382
20383 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
20384 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
20385 passed.
20386
20387 @item vm
20388 @cindex virtual machine
20389 @cindex VM
20390 @anchor{guix system vm}
20391 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
20392 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
20393 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
20394 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
20395 emulated machine:
20396
20397 @example
20398 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -net user
20399 @end example
20400
20401 The VM shares its store with the host system.
20402
20403 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
20404 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
20405 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
20406 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
20407
20408 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
20409 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
20410 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
20411
20412 @example
20413 guix system vm my-config.scm \
20414 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
20415 @end example
20416
20417 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
20418 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
20419 store of the host can then be mounted.
20420
20421 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
20422 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
20423 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
20424 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
20425 size of the image.
20426
20427 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
20428 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
20429 @item vm-image
20430 @itemx disk-image
20431 @itemx docker-image
20432 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
20433 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
20434 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
20435 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
20436 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
20437 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
20438 @code{docker-image}.
20439
20440 You can specify the root file system type by using the
20441 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
20442
20443 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
20444 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
20445 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
20446
20447 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
20448 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
20449 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
20450 using the following command:
20451
20452 @example
20453 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
20454 @end example
20455
20456 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
20457 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
20458 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
20459 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
20460 Docker container using commands like the following:
20461
20462 @example
20463 image_id="$(docker load < guixsd-docker-image.tar.gz)"
20464 docker run -e GUIX_NEW_SYSTEM=/var/guix/profiles/system \\
20465 --entrypoint /var/guix/profiles/system/profile/bin/guile \\
20466 $image_id /var/guix/profiles/system/boot
20467 @end example
20468
20469 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
20470 will boot the GuixSD system in the usual manner, which means it will
20471 start any services you have defined in the operating system
20472 configuration. Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
20473 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
20474 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
20475 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
20476 @code{docker run}.
20477
20478 @item container
20479 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
20480 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
20481 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
20482 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
20483 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
20484 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
20485
20486 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
20487 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
20488 system.
20489
20490 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
20491 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
20492 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
20493
20494 @example
20495 guix system container my-config.scm \
20496 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
20497 @end example
20498
20499 @quotation Note
20500 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
20501 @end quotation
20502
20503 @end table
20504
20505 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
20506 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
20507 following:
20508
20509 @table @option
20510 @item --expression=@var{expr}
20511 @itemx -e @var{expr}
20512 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
20513 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
20514 operating system.
20515 This is used to generate the GuixSD installer @pxref{Building the
20516 Installation Image}).
20517
20518 @item --system=@var{system}
20519 @itemx -s @var{system}
20520 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
20521 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
20522
20523 @item --derivation
20524 @itemx -d
20525 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
20526 building anything.
20527
20528 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
20529 @itemx -t @var{type}
20530 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
20531 @var{type} on the image.
20532
20533 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
20534
20535 @cindex ISO-9660 format
20536 @cindex CD image format
20537 @cindex DVD image format
20538 @code{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
20539 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
20540
20541 @item --image-size=@var{size}
20542 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
20543 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
20544 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
20545 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
20546
20547 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
20548 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
20549 @var{file}.
20550
20551 @item --root=@var{file}
20552 @itemx -r @var{file}
20553 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
20554 collector root.
20555
20556 @item --skip-checks
20557 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
20558
20559 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
20560 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
20561 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
20562 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
20563 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
20564 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
20565
20566 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
20567 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
20568 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
20569
20570 @table @code
20571 @item nothing-special
20572 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
20573
20574 @item backtrace
20575 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
20576
20577 @item debug
20578 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
20579 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
20580 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
20581 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
20582 a list of available debugging commands.
20583 @end table
20584 @end table
20585
20586 @quotation Note
20587 All the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
20588 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
20589 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
20590 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
20591 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
20592 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
20593 @end quotation
20594
20595 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
20596 your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
20597 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
20598 bootloader boot menu:
20599
20600 @table @code
20601
20602 @item list-generations
20603 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
20604 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
20605 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
20606 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
20607
20608 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
20609 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
20610 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
20611 generations that are up to 10 days old:
20612
20613 @example
20614 $ guix system list-generations 10d
20615 @end example
20616
20617 @end table
20618
20619 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
20620 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
20621 each other:
20622
20623 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
20624 @table @code
20625
20626 @item extension-graph
20627 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
20628 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
20629 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
20630 extensions.)
20631
20632 The command:
20633
20634 @example
20635 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
20636 @end example
20637
20638 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
20639
20640 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
20641 @item shepherd-graph
20642 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
20643 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
20644 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
20645 example graph.
20646
20647 @end table
20648
20649 @node Running GuixSD in a VM
20650 @subsection Running GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
20651
20652 @cindex virtual machine
20653 To run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM), one can either use the
20654 pre-built GuixSD VM image distributed at
20655 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/guix/guixsd-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz}
20656 , or build their own virtual machine image using @command{guix system
20657 vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in
20658 qcow2 format, which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can
20659 efficiently use.
20660
20661 @cindex QEMU
20662 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
20663 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
20664 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
20665 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
20666 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
20667 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
20668
20669 @example
20670 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
20671 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
20672 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
20673 @end example
20674
20675 Here is what each of these options means:
20676
20677 @table @code
20678 @item qemu-system-x86_64
20679 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
20680 host.
20681
20682 @item -net user
20683 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
20684 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
20685 guest OS online.
20686
20687 @item -net nic,model=virtio
20688 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
20689 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
20690 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
20691 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
20692
20693 @item -enable-kvm
20694 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
20695 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
20696 faster.
20697
20698 @item -m 256
20699 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
20700 which may be insufficient for some operations.
20701
20702 @item /tmp/qemu-image
20703 The file name of the qcow2 image.
20704 @end table
20705
20706 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
20707 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-net user} flag by default.
20708 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
20709 to your system definition and start the VM using
20710 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -net user}. An important caveat of using
20711 @command{-net user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
20712 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
20713 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
20714
20715 @subsubsection Connecting Through SSH
20716
20717 @cindex SSH
20718 @cindex SSH server
20719 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add a SSH server like @code{(dropbear-service)}
20720 or @code{(lsh-service)} to your VM. The @code{(lsh-service}) doesn't currently
20721 boot unsupervised. It requires you to type some characters to initialize the
20722 randomness generator. In addition you need to forward the SSH port, 22 by
20723 default, to the host. You can do this with
20724
20725 @example
20726 `guix system vm config.scm` -net user,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
20727 @end example
20728
20729 To connect to the VM you can run
20730
20731 @example
20732 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
20733 @end example
20734
20735 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
20736 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
20737 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
20738 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
20739 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
20740
20741 @subsubsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
20742
20743 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
20744 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
20745 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
20746 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
20747
20748 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
20749 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
20750
20751 @example
20752 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
20753 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
20754 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
20755 name=com.redhat.spice.0
20756 @end example
20757
20758 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
20759
20760 @node Defining Services
20761 @subsection Defining Services
20762
20763 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
20764 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
20765 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
20766
20767 @menu
20768 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
20769 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
20770 * Service Reference:: API reference.
20771 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
20772 @end menu
20773
20774 @node Service Composition
20775 @subsubsection Service Composition
20776
20777 @cindex services
20778 @cindex daemons
20779 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
20780 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
20781 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
20782 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
20783 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
20784 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
20785 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
20786 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
20787 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
20788 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
20789 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
20790 of the system.
20791
20792 @cindex service extensions
20793 GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
20794 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the GuixSD
20795 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
20796 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
20797 Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
20798 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
20799 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
20800 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
20801 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
20802 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
20803 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
20804
20805 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
20806 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
20807 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
20808
20809 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
20810
20811 @cindex system service
20812 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
20813 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
20814 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
20815 to learn about the other service types shown here.
20816 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
20817 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
20818 particular operating system definition.
20819
20820 @cindex service types
20821 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
20822 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
20823 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
20824 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
20825 different parameters.
20826
20827 The following section describes the programming interface for service
20828 types and services.
20829
20830 @node Service Types and Services
20831 @subsubsection Service Types and Services
20832
20833 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
20834 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
20835 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
20836
20837 @example
20838 (define guix-service-type
20839 (service-type
20840 (name 'guix)
20841 (extensions
20842 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
20843 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
20844 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
20845 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
20846 @end example
20847
20848 @noindent
20849 It defines three things:
20850
20851 @enumerate
20852 @item
20853 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
20854
20855 @item
20856 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
20857 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
20858 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
20859
20860 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
20861 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
20862
20863 @item
20864 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
20865 @end enumerate
20866
20867 In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
20868
20869 @table @var
20870 @item shepherd-root-service-type
20871 The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
20872 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
20873 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
20874 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
20875
20876 @item account-service-type
20877 This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
20878 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
20879 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
20880 guix-daemon}).
20881
20882 @item activation-service-type
20883 Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
20884 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
20885 booted.
20886 @end table
20887
20888 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
20889
20890 @example
20891 (service guix-service-type
20892 (guix-configuration
20893 (build-accounts 5)
20894 (use-substitutes? #f)))
20895 @end example
20896
20897 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
20898 the parameters of this specific service instance.
20899 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
20900 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
20901 value is omitted, the default value specified by
20902 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
20903
20904 @example
20905 (service guix-service-type)
20906 @end example
20907
20908 @var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
20909 services but is not extensible itself.
20910
20911 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
20912
20913 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
20914
20915 @example
20916 (define udev-service-type
20917 (service-type (name 'udev)
20918 (extensions
20919 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
20920 udev-shepherd-service)))
20921
20922 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
20923 (extend (lambda (config rules)
20924 (match config
20925 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
20926 (udev-configuration
20927 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
20928 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
20929 @end example
20930
20931 This is the service type for the
20932 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
20933 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
20934 extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
20935
20936 @table @code
20937 @item compose
20938 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
20939 services of this type.
20940
20941 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
20942 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
20943
20944 @item extend
20945 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
20946 the composition of the extensions.
20947
20948 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
20949 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
20950 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
20951 list of contributed rules.
20952
20953 @item description
20954 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
20955 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
20956 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
20957 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
20958 @end table
20959
20960 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
20961 @var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
20962 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
20963
20964 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
20965 interface for services.
20966
20967 @node Service Reference
20968 @subsubsection Service Reference
20969
20970 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
20971 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
20972 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
20973 @code{(gnu services)} module.
20974
20975 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
20976 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
20977 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
20978 this particular service instance.
20979
20980 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
20981 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
20982 raised.
20983
20984 For instance, this:
20985
20986 @example
20987 (service openssh-service-type)
20988 @end example
20989
20990 @noindent
20991 is equivalent to this:
20992
20993 @example
20994 (service openssh-service-type
20995 (openssh-configuration))
20996 @end example
20997
20998 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
20999 with the default configuration.
21000 @end deffn
21001
21002 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
21003 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
21004 @end deffn
21005
21006 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
21007 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
21008 @end deffn
21009
21010 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
21011 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
21012 parameters.
21013 @end deffn
21014
21015 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
21016
21017 @example
21018 (define s
21019 (service nginx-service-type
21020 (nginx-configuration
21021 (nginx nginx)
21022 (log-directory log-directory)
21023 (run-directory run-directory)
21024 (file config-file))))
21025
21026 (service? s)
21027 @result{} #t
21028
21029 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
21030 @result{} #t
21031 @end example
21032
21033 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
21034 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
21035 @var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
21036 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
21037 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
21038 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
21039 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
21040 common pattern.
21041
21042 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
21043 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
21044
21045 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
21046 clauses. Each clause has the form:
21047
21048 @example
21049 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
21050 @end example
21051
21052 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
21053 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
21054 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
21055 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
21056 @var{type}.
21057
21058 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
21059 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
21060 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
21061 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
21062 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
21063 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
21064
21065 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
21066
21067 @end deffn
21068
21069 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
21070 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
21071 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
21072 @code{operating-system} declaration.
21073
21074 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
21075 @cindex service type
21076 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
21077 and Services}).
21078
21079 @table @asis
21080 @item @code{name}
21081 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
21082
21083 @item @code{extensions}
21084 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
21085
21086 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
21087 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
21088 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
21089 services.
21090
21091 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
21092 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
21093 extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
21094 the service instance.
21095
21096 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
21097 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
21098
21099 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
21100 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first argument
21101 and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
21102 second argument.
21103 @end table
21104
21105 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
21106 @end deftp
21107
21108 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
21109 @var{compute}
21110 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
21111 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
21112 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
21113 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
21114 @end deffn
21115
21116 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
21117 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
21118 @end deffn
21119
21120 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
21121 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
21122 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
21123 provides a shorthand for this.
21124
21125 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
21126 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
21127 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
21128 service is an instance.
21129
21130 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
21131 an additional job:
21132
21133 @example
21134 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
21135 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
21136 @end example
21137 @end deffn
21138
21139 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
21140 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
21141 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
21142 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
21143 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
21144 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
21145 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
21146
21147 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
21148 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
21149 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
21150 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
21151 @end deffn
21152
21153 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
21154 service types, some of which are listed below.
21155
21156 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
21157 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
21158 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
21159 @end defvr
21160
21161 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
21162 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
21163 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
21164 @end defvr
21165
21166 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
21167 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
21168 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
21169 passing it name/file tuples such as:
21170
21171 @example
21172 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
21173 @end example
21174
21175 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
21176 pointing to the given file.
21177 @end defvr
21178
21179 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
21180 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
21181 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
21182 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
21183 @end defvr
21184
21185 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
21186 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
21187 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
21188 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
21189 @end defvr
21190
21191
21192 @node Shepherd Services
21193 @subsubsection Shepherd Services
21194
21195 @cindex shepherd services
21196 @cindex PID 1
21197 @cindex init system
21198 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
21199 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the GuixSD
21200 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
21201 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
21202 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
21203
21204 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
21205 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
21206 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
21207 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
21208 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
21209
21210 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
21211
21212 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
21213 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
21214 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
21215
21216 The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
21217 PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
21218 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
21219
21220 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
21221 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
21222
21223 @table @asis
21224 @item @code{provision}
21225 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
21226
21227 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
21228 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
21229 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
21230 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
21231
21232 @item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
21233 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
21234
21235 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
21236 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
21237 underlying process dies.
21238
21239 @item @code{start}
21240 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
21241 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
21242 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
21243 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
21244 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
21245 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
21246
21247 @item @code{documentation}
21248 A documentation string, as shown when running:
21249
21250 @example
21251 herd doc @var{service-name}
21252 @end example
21253
21254 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
21255 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
21256
21257 @item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
21258 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
21259 @code{stop} are evaluated.
21260
21261 @end table
21262 @end deftp
21263
21264 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
21265 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
21266
21267 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
21268 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
21269 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
21270 @end defvr
21271
21272 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
21273 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
21274 @end defvr
21275
21276
21277 @node Documentation
21278 @section Documentation
21279
21280 @cindex documentation, searching for
21281 @cindex searching for documentation
21282 @cindex Info, documentation format
21283 @cindex man pages
21284 @cindex manual pages
21285 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
21286 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
21287 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
21288 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
21289 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
21290 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
21291
21292 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
21293 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
21294 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
21295
21296 @example
21297 $ info -k TLS
21298 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
21299 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
21300 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
21301 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
21302 @dots{}
21303 @end example
21304
21305 @noindent
21306 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
21307
21308 @example
21309 $ man -k TLS
21310 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
21311 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
21312 @dots {}
21313 @end example
21314
21315 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
21316 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
21317 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
21318 respected.
21319
21320 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
21321 running, say:
21322
21323 @example
21324 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
21325 @end example
21326
21327 @noindent
21328 or:
21329
21330 @example
21331 $ man certtool
21332 @end example
21333
21334 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
21335 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
21336 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
21337 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
21338 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
21339 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
21340
21341 @node Installing Debugging Files
21342 @section Installing Debugging Files
21343
21344 @cindex debugging files
21345 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
21346 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
21347 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
21348 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
21349 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
21350
21351 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
21352 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
21353 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
21354 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
21355 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
21356 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
21357 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
21358
21359 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
21360 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
21361 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
21362 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
21363 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
21364 with GDB}).
21365
21366 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
21367 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
21368 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
21369 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
21370 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
21371 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
21372 Guile:
21373
21374 @example
21375 guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
21376 @end example
21377
21378 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
21379 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
21380 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
21381 GDB}):
21382
21383 @example
21384 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
21385 @end example
21386
21387 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
21388 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
21389
21390 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
21391 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
21392 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
21393 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
21394 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
21395 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
21396
21397 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
21398 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
21399 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
21400 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
21401 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
21402 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
21403 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
21404 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
21405
21406
21407 @node Security Updates
21408 @section Security Updates
21409
21410 @cindex security updates
21411 @cindex security vulnerabilities
21412 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
21413 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
21414 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
21415 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
21416 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
21417 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
21418 distribution:
21419
21420 @smallexample
21421 $ guix lint -c cve
21422 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
21423 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
21424 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
21425 @dots{}
21426 @end smallexample
21427
21428 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
21429
21430 @quotation Note
21431 As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described below is considered
21432 ``beta''.
21433 @end quotation
21434
21435 Guix follows a functional
21436 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
21437 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
21438 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
21439 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
21440 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
21441 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
21442 desired.
21443
21444 @cindex grafts
21445 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
21446 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
21447 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
21448 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
21449 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
21450 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
21451 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
21452
21453 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
21454 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
21455 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
21456 Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
21457 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
21458 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
21459
21460 @example
21461 (define bash
21462 (package
21463 (name "bash")
21464 ;; @dots{}
21465 (replacement bash-fixed)))
21466 @end example
21467
21468 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
21469 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
21470 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
21471 @var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
21472 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
21473 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
21474 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
21475 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
21476
21477 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
21478 the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and @var{bash} in the example
21479 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
21480 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
21481 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
21482 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
21483 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
21484
21485 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
21486 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
21487 Thus, the command:
21488
21489 @example
21490 guix build bash --no-grafts
21491 @end example
21492
21493 @noindent
21494 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
21495
21496 @example
21497 guix build bash
21498 @end example
21499
21500 @noindent
21501 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
21502 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
21503
21504 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
21505 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
21506
21507 @example
21508 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
21509 @end example
21510
21511 @noindent
21512 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
21513 Likewise for a complete GuixSD system generation:
21514
21515 @example
21516 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
21517 @end example
21518
21519 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
21520 @command{lsof} command:
21521
21522 @example
21523 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
21524 @end example
21525
21526
21527 @node Package Modules
21528 @section Package Modules
21529
21530 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
21531 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
21532 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
21533 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
21534 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
21535 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
21536 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
21537 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
21538 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
21539 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
21540 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
21541
21542 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
21543 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
21544 instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
21545 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
21546 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
21547 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
21548
21549 @cindex customization, of packages
21550 @cindex package module search path
21551 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
21552 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
21553 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
21554 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
21555 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
21556 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
21557 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
21558 will not be visible by default. Users can invoke commands such as
21559 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} with the
21560 @code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
21561 yet, they can use the
21562 @code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
21563 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
21564 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
21565 variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
21566 honored by all the user interfaces.
21567
21568 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
21569 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
21570 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
21571 over the own modules of the distribution.
21572 @end defvr
21573
21574 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
21575 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
21576 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
21577 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
21578 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
21579 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
21580
21581 @node Packaging Guidelines
21582 @section Packaging Guidelines
21583
21584 @cindex packages, creating
21585 The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
21586 packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
21587 grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
21588 help.
21589
21590 Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
21591 @dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
21592 all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
21593 essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
21594 build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
21595 it, and adding @dfn{package metadata} along with that recipe, such as a
21596 description and licensing information.
21597
21598 In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
21599 Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
21600 written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
21601 for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
21602 and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
21603 However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
21604 creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
21605 @pxref{Defining Packages}.
21606
21607 Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
21608 source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
21609 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
21610 called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
21611 (@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
21612
21613 @example
21614 ./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
21615 @end example
21616
21617 Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
21618 it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
21619 command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
21620 build log.
21621
21622 If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
21623 the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
21624 clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
21625 the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
21626
21627 @example
21628 ./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
21629 @end example
21630
21631 Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
21632 (@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
21633 help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
21634 new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
21635 @url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
21636 system}.
21637
21638 @cindex substituter
21639 Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
21640 @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
21641 @code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
21642 package automatically downloads binaries from there
21643 (@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
21644 needed is to review and apply the patch.
21645
21646
21647 @menu
21648 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
21649 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
21650 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
21651 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
21652 * Python Modules:: A touch of British comedy.
21653 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
21654 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
21655 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
21656 @end menu
21657
21658 @node Software Freedom
21659 @subsection Software Freedom
21660
21661 @c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
21662 @cindex free software
21663 The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
21664 freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
21665 users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
21666 essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
21667 in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
21668 modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
21669 software that conveys these four freedoms.
21670
21671 In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
21672 @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
21673 software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
21674 reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
21675 discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
21676
21677 Some otherwise free upstream package sources contain a small and optional
21678 subset that violates the above guidelines, for instance because this subset
21679 is itself non-free code. When that happens, the offending items are removed
21680 with appropriate patches or code snippets in the @code{origin} form of the
21681 package (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This way, @code{guix
21682 build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
21683 upstream source.
21684
21685
21686 @node Package Naming
21687 @subsection Package Naming
21688
21689 @cindex package name
21690 A package has actually two names associated with it:
21691 First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
21692 @code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
21693 Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
21694 the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
21695 is used by package management commands such as
21696 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
21697
21698 Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
21699 the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
21700 hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
21701 SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
21702
21703 We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
21704 already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
21705 Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
21706 the Python and Perl languages.
21707
21708 Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
21709
21710
21711 @node Version Numbers
21712 @subsection Version Numbers
21713
21714 @cindex package version
21715 We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
21716 project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
21717 two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
21718 different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
21719 in @ref{Package Naming}
21720 for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
21721 by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
21722 distinguish the two versions.
21723
21724 The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
21725 package and does not contain any version number.
21726
21727 For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
21728
21729 @example
21730 (define-public gtk+
21731 (package
21732 (name "gtk+")
21733 (version "3.9.12")
21734 ...))
21735 (define-public gtk+-2
21736 (package
21737 (name "gtk+")
21738 (version "2.24.20")
21739 ...))
21740 @end example
21741 If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
21742 @example
21743 (define-public gtk+-3.8
21744 (package
21745 (name "gtk+")
21746 (version "3.8.2")
21747 ...))
21748 @end example
21749
21750 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
21751 @c for a discussion of what follows.
21752 @cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
21753 Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
21754 (VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
21755 because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
21756 release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
21757 the @code{version} field?
21758
21759 Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
21760 visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
21761 version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
21762 --upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
21763 identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
21764 a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
21765 snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
21766
21767 @example
21768 2.0.11-3.cabba9e
21769 ^ ^ ^
21770 | | `-- upstream commit ID
21771 | |
21772 | `--- Guix package revision
21773 |
21774 latest upstream version
21775 @end example
21776
21777 It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
21778 field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
21779 aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
21780 limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
21781 kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
21782 @code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities. A typical package
21783 definition may look like this:
21784
21785 @example
21786 (define my-package
21787 (let ((commit "c3f29bc928d5900971f65965feaae59e1272a3f7")
21788 (revision "1")) ;Guix package revision
21789 (package
21790 (version (git-version "0.9" revision commit))
21791 (source (origin
21792 (method git-fetch)
21793 (uri (git-reference
21794 (url "git://example.org/my-package.git")
21795 (commit commit)))
21796 (sha256 (base32 "1mbikn@dots{}"))
21797 (file-name (git-file-name name version))))
21798 ;; @dots{}
21799 )))
21800 @end example
21801
21802 @node Synopses and Descriptions
21803 @subsection Synopses and Descriptions
21804
21805 @cindex package description
21806 @cindex package synopsis
21807 As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
21808 synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
21809 descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
21810 --search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
21811 determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
21812 packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
21813
21814 Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
21815 period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
21816 not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
21817 tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
21818 is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
21819 used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
21820 matching a pattern''.
21821
21822 Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
21823 audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
21824 might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
21825 fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
21826 is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
21827 application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
21828 something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
21829 hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
21830 looking for.
21831
21832 Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
21833 sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
21834 Please avoid marketing phrases such as ``world-leading'',
21835 ``industrial-strength'', and ``next-generation'', and avoid superlatives
21836 like ``the most advanced''---they are not helpful to users looking for a
21837 package and may even sound suspicious. Instead, try to be factual,
21838 mentioning use cases and features.
21839
21840 @cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
21841 Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
21842 ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
21843 hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
21844 should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
21845 curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
21846 (@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
21847 such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
21848 appropriately.
21849
21850 Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
21851 @uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
21852 Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
21853 their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
21854 the language specified by the current locale.
21855
21856 To allow @command{xgettext} to extract them as translatable strings,
21857 synopses and descriptions @emph{must be literal strings}. This means
21858 that you cannot use @code{string-append} or @code{format} to construct
21859 these strings:
21860
21861 @lisp
21862 (package
21863 ;; @dots{}
21864 (synopsis "This is translatable")
21865 (description (string-append "This is " "*not*" " translatable.")))
21866 @end lisp
21867
21868 Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
21869 attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
21870 additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
21871 to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
21872 special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
21873 Gettext}):
21874
21875 @example
21876 ;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
21877 (description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
21878 for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
21879 @end example
21880
21881
21882 @node Python Modules
21883 @subsection Python Modules
21884
21885 @cindex python
21886 We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
21887 @code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
21888 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
21889 seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
21890 the word @code{python}.
21891
21892 Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
21893 If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
21894 @code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
21895 @code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
21896 packages with the corresponding names.
21897
21898 If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
21899 for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
21900 @code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}. If the project name
21901 starts with @code{py} (e.g. @code{pytz}), we keep it and prefix it as
21902 described above.
21903
21904 @subsubsection Specifying Dependencies
21905 @cindex inputs, for Python packages
21906
21907 Dependency information for Python packages is usually available in the
21908 package source tree, with varying degrees of accuracy: in the
21909 @file{setup.py} file, in @file{requirements.txt}, or in @file{tox.ini}.
21910
21911 Your mission, when writing a recipe for a Python package, is to map
21912 these dependencies to the appropriate type of ``input'' (@pxref{package
21913 Reference, inputs}). Although the @code{pypi} importer normally does a
21914 good job (@pxref{Invoking guix import}), you may want to check the
21915 following check list to determine which dependency goes where.
21916
21917 @itemize
21918
21919 @item
21920 We currently package Python 2 with @code{setuptools} and @code{pip}
21921 installed like Python 3.4 has per default. Thus you don't need to
21922 specify either of these as an input. @command{guix lint} will warn you
21923 if you do.
21924
21925 @item
21926 Python dependencies required at run time go into
21927 @code{propagated-inputs}. They are typically defined with the
21928 @code{install_requires} keyword in @file{setup.py}, or in the
21929 @file{requirements.txt} file.
21930
21931 @item
21932 Python packages required only at build time---e.g., those listed with
21933 the @code{setup_requires} keyword in @file{setup.py}---or only for
21934 testing---e.g., those in @code{tests_require}---go into
21935 @code{native-inputs}. The rationale is that (1) they do not need to be
21936 propagated because they are not needed at run time, and (2) in a
21937 cross-compilation context, it's the ``native'' input that we'd want.
21938
21939 Examples are the @code{pytest}, @code{mock}, and @code{nose} test
21940 frameworks. Of course if any of these packages is also required at
21941 run-time, it needs to go to @code{propagated-inputs}.
21942
21943 @item
21944 Anything that does not fall in the previous categories goes to
21945 @code{inputs}, for example programs or C libraries required for building
21946 Python packages containing C extensions.
21947
21948 @item
21949 If a Python package has optional dependencies (@code{extras_require}),
21950 it is up to you to decide whether to add them or not, based on their
21951 usefulness/overhead ratio (@pxref{Submitting Patches, @command{guix
21952 size}}).
21953
21954 @end itemize
21955
21956
21957 @node Perl Modules
21958 @subsection Perl Modules
21959
21960 @cindex perl
21961 Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
21962 using the lowercase upstream name.
21963 For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
21964 replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
21965 @code{perl-}.
21966 So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
21967 Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
21968 are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
21969 @code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
21970 prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
21971
21972
21973 @node Java Packages
21974 @subsection Java Packages
21975
21976 @cindex java
21977 Java programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
21978 using the lowercase upstream name.
21979
21980 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages,
21981 it is desirable that the name of a package for a Java package is
21982 prefixed with @code{java-}. If a project already contains the word
21983 @code{java}, we drop this; for instance, the package @code{ngsjava} is
21984 packaged under the name @code{java-ngs}.
21985
21986 For Java packages containing a single class or a small class hierarchy,
21987 we use the lowercase class name, replace all occurrences of @code{.} by
21988 dashes and prepend the prefix @code{java-}. So the class
21989 @code{apache.commons.cli} becomes package
21990 @code{java-apache-commons-cli}.
21991
21992
21993 @node Fonts
21994 @subsection Fonts
21995
21996 @cindex fonts
21997 For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
21998 purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
21999 we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
22000 applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
22001 are part of TeX Live.
22002
22003 To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
22004 containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
22005 upstream package name.
22006
22007 The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
22008 @code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
22009 if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
22010 replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
22011 to lower case).
22012 For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
22013 @code{font-sil-gentium}.
22014
22015 For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
22016 is used in the place of the font family name.
22017 For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
22018 Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
22019 These could be packaged separately under the names
22020 @code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
22021 under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
22022 @code{font-liberation}.
22023
22024 In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
22025 are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
22026 is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
22027 @code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
22028 fonts.
22029
22030
22031
22032 @node Bootstrapping
22033 @section Bootstrapping
22034
22035 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
22036
22037 @cindex bootstrapping
22038
22039 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
22040 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
22041 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
22042 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
22043 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
22044 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
22045 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
22046 a ``regular user''.
22047
22048 @cindex bootstrap binaries
22049 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
22050 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
22051 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
22052 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
22053 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
22054 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
22055 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
22056 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
22057 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
22058
22059 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
22060 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
22061
22062 @unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
22063
22064 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
22065 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
22066 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
22067
22068 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
22069 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
22070 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
22071 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
22072
22073 @example
22074 guix graph -t derivation \
22075 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
22076 | dot -Tps > t.ps
22077 @end example
22078
22079 At this level of detail, things are
22080 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
22081 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
22082 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
22083 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
22084 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
22085 (@pxref{The Store}).
22086
22087 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
22088 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
22089 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
22090 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
22091 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
22092 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
22093 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
22094 tarball to be unpacked.
22095
22096 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
22097 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
22098 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
22099 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
22100 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
22101 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
22102 in the store, using the original layout. The
22103 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
22104 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
22105 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
22106 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
22107
22108 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
22109 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
22110 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
22111
22112
22113 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
22114
22115 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
22116 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
22117 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
22118 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
22119 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
22120 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
22121 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
22122
22123 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
22124 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
22125 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
22126 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
22127 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
22128 package from source. The command:
22129
22130 @example
22131 guix graph -t bag \
22132 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
22133 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
22134 @end example
22135
22136 @noindent
22137 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
22138 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
22139 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
22140 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
22141
22142 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
22143
22144 @c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
22145 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
22146 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
22147 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
22148 built.
22149
22150 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
22151 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
22152 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
22153 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
22154
22155 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
22156 GCC uses @code{ld}
22157 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
22158 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
22159 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
22160
22161 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
22162 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
22163 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
22164 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
22165 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
22166
22167
22168 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
22169
22170 @cindex bootstrap binaries
22171 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
22172 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
22173 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
22174 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
22175
22176 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
22177 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
22178 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
22179
22180 @example
22181 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
22182 @end example
22183
22184 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
22185 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
22186 this section.
22187
22188 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
22189 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
22190 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
22191 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
22192 know.
22193
22194 @unnumberedsubsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
22195
22196 Our bootstrap binaries currently include GCC, Guile, etc. That's a lot
22197 of binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these
22198 big chunks of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it
22199 hard to establish what source code produced them. Every unauditable
22200 binary also leaves us vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by
22201 Ken Thompson in the 1984 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
22202
22203 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
22204 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
22205 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
22206 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
22207 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
22208
22209 The @uref{http://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
22210 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
22211 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
22212 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
22213 a simple and auditable assembler. Your help is welcome!
22214
22215
22216 @node Porting
22217 @section Porting to a New Platform
22218
22219 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
22220 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
22221 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
22222 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
22223 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
22224 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
22225 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
22226
22227 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
22228 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
22229 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
22230 one:
22231
22232 @example
22233 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
22234 @end example
22235
22236 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
22237 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
22238 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
22239 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
22240 taught about the new platform.
22241
22242 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
22243 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
22244 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
22245 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
22246 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
22247 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules do download it for
22248 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
22249 as well.
22250
22251 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
22252 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
22253 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
22254 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
22255 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
22256 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
22257 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
22258 reason.
22259
22260 @c *********************************************************************
22261 @include contributing.texi
22262
22263 @c *********************************************************************
22264 @node Acknowledgments
22265 @chapter Acknowledgments
22266
22267 Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
22268 which was designed and
22269 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
22270 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
22271 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
22272 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
22273 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
22274
22275 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
22276 an inspiration for Guix.
22277
22278 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
22279 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
22280 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
22281 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
22282 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
22283
22284
22285 @c *********************************************************************
22286 @node GNU Free Documentation License
22287 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
22288 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
22289 @include fdl-1.3.texi
22290
22291 @c *********************************************************************
22292 @node Concept Index
22293 @unnumbered Concept Index
22294 @printindex cp
22295
22296 @node Programming Index
22297 @unnumbered Programming Index
22298 @syncodeindex tp fn
22299 @syncodeindex vr fn
22300 @printindex fn
22301
22302 @bye
22303
22304 @c Local Variables:
22305 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
22306 @c End: